blob: b6a30de397d63ee03dcd745a15f36e62daf60649 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1a34d572014-02-03 00:41:29 +01007 2014/02/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100158By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
160leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
161start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200162
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100163HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
164 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
165 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
166 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
167 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
168 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
169 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
1721.2. HTTP request
173-----------------
174
175First, let's consider this HTTP request :
176
177 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100178 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
180 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
181 3 User-agent: my small browser
182 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
183 5 Accept: image/png
184
185
1861.2.1. The Request line
187-----------------------
188
189Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
190
191 - a METHOD : GET
192 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
193 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
194
195All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
196which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
197followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
198is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
199desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
200the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
201
202The URI itself can have several forms :
203
204 - A "relative URI" :
205
206 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
209 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
210
211 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
212
213 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
216 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
217 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
218 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
219 must accept this form too.
220
221 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
222 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
223 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
226 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
227 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
228 other protocols too.
229
230In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
231mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
232on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
233It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
234specific to the language, framework or application in use.
235
236
2371.2.2. The request headers
238--------------------------
239
240The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
241beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
242an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
243Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
244values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
245encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
246the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
247define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
248
249Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
250their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
251"Connection:" header).
252
253The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
254that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
255is one valid form of empty line.
256
257Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
258headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
259about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
260application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
261
262Important note:
263 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
264 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
265 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
266 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
267
268
2691.3. HTTP response
270------------------
271
272An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
273messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
274
275 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100276 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200277 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
278 2 Content-length: 350
279 3 Content-Type: text/html
280
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200281As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
282codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
283response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100284continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
285the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
286following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
287sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
288(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
289correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
290such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
291state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
292over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
293if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
294information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
2971.3.1. The Response line
298------------------------
299
300Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
301
302 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
303 - a status code : 200
304 - a reason : OK
305
306The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200307 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
309 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
310 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
311 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
312
313Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100314"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
316messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
317or "Authentication Required".
318
319Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
320
321 Code When / reason
322 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
323 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
324 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100326 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200328 400 for an invalid or too large request
329 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
330 accessing the stats page)
331 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
332 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
333 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
334 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
335 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
336 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
337 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
338 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
339 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
340
341The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3424.2).
343
344
3451.3.2. The response headers
346---------------------------
347
348Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
349the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
350details.
351
352
3532. Configuring HAProxy
354----------------------
355
3562.1. Configuration file format
357------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200358
359HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
360
361 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
362 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
363 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
364 "frontend" and "backend".
365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
367referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
368delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100369preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100370escaped by doubling them.
371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372
3732.2. Time format
374----------------
375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100376Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
378otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
379numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
380for every keyword. Supported units are :
381
382 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
383 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
384 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
385 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
386 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
387 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
388
389
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003902.3. Examples
391-------------
392
393 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
394 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
395 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
396 global
397 daemon
398 maxconn 256
399
400 defaults
401 mode http
402 timeout connect 5000ms
403 timeout client 50000ms
404 timeout server 50000ms
405
406 frontend http-in
407 bind *:80
408 default_backend servers
409
410 backend servers
411 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
412
413
414 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
415 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
416 global
417 daemon
418 maxconn 256
419
420 defaults
421 mode http
422 timeout connect 5000ms
423 timeout client 50000ms
424 timeout server 50000ms
425
426 listen http-in
427 bind *:80
428 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
429
430
431Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
432
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100433 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200434
435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004363. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200437--------------------
438
439Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
440are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
441of them have command-line equivalents.
442
443The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
444
445 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200448 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 - daemon
450 - gid
451 - group
452 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100453 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200454 - nbproc
455 - pidfile
456 - uid
457 - ulimit-n
458 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200459 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100460 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200461 - node
462 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100463 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100464
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200465 * Performance tuning
466 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200467 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100468 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100469 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100470 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200471 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200472 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200473 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474 - noepoll
475 - nokqueue
476 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100477 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200478 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200479 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200480 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100481 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100482 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200483 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100484 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100485 - tune.maxaccept
486 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200487 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200488 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100489 - tune.rcvbuf.client
490 - tune.rcvbuf.server
491 - tune.sndbuf.client
492 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100493 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100494 - tune.ssl.lifetime
495 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100496 - tune.zlib.memlevel
497 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499 * Debugging
500 - debug
501 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200502
503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005043.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505------------------------------------
506
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200507ca-base <dir>
508 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200509 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
510 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200511
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200512chroot <jail dir>
513 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
514 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
515 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
516 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
517 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
518 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100519
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100520cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
521 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
522 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
523 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
524 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
525 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
526 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
527 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
528 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
529 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
530 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
531 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
532 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
533 they overlap.
534
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200535crt-base <dir>
536 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
537 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
538 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
539
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540daemon
541 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
542 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
543 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
544
545gid <number>
546 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
547 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
548 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100549 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
550 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200551 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100552
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200553group <group name>
554 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
555 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100556
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200557log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
559 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100560 configured with "log global".
561
562 <address> can be one of:
563
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100564 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
566 port).
567
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100568 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
569 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
570 port).
571
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100572 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
573 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
574 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
575 writeable).
576
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100577 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
578 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
579 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
580 in Bourne shell.
581
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100582 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200583
584 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
585 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
586 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
587
588 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200589 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
590 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
591 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
592 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
593 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
594 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200596 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100598log-send-hostname [<string>]
599 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
600 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
601 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
602 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
603 the logs.
604
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000605log-tag <string>
606 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
607 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
608 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
609 running on the same host.
610
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611nbproc <number>
612 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
613 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
614 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
615 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
616 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
617
618pidfile <pidfile>
619 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
620 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
621 starting the process. See also "daemon".
622
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100623stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200624 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
625 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
626 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
627 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
628 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
629 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
630 the number of processes used.
631
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100632ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
633 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
634 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
635 that are negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
636 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
637 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
638 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
639 "bind" keyword for more information.
640
641ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
642 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
643 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
644 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
645 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
646 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
647 information.
648
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100649ssl-server-verify [none|required]
650 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
651 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
652 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
653
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200654stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
655 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
656 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
657 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
658 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200659
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200660 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
661 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
662 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200663
664stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
665 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
666 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100667 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200668
669stats maxconn <connections>
670 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
671 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673uid <number>
674 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
675 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
676 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
677 one. See also "gid" and "user".
678
679ulimit-n <number>
680 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
681 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
682 option.
683
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100684unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
685 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
686
687 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
688 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
689 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
690 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
691 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
692 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
693 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
694 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
695 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
696 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
697
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698user <user name>
699 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
700 See also "uid" and "group".
701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200702node <name>
703 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
704
705 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
706 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
707 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
708 traffic.
709
710description <text>
711 Add a text that describes the instance.
712
713 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
714 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
715 "<" and ">" characters.
716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007183.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719-----------------------
720
721maxconn <number>
722 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
723 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
724 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
725 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
726
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200727maxconnrate <number>
728 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
729 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
730 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
731 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
732 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
733 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
734 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
735 fairness.
736
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100737maxcomprate <number>
738 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
739 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
740 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
741 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
742 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
743 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
744 default value.
745
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100746maxcompcpuusage <number>
747 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
748 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
749 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
750 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
751 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
752 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
753 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
754 process down and from introducing high latencies.
755
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100756maxpipes <number>
757 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
758 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
759 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
760 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
761 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
762 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
763
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200764maxsessrate <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
766 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
767 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
768 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
769 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
770 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
771 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
772 fairness.
773
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200774maxsslconn <number>
775 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
776 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
777 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
778 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
779 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
780 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
781 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
782
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200783maxsslrate <number>
784 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
785 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
786 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
787 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
788 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
789 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
790 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
791 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
792 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
793 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
794
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100795maxzlibmem <number>
796 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
797 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
798 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100799 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
800 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
801 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
802
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200803noepoll
804 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
805 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100806 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807
808nokqueue
809 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
810 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
811 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
812
813nopoll
814 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
815 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100816 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100817 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100819nosplice
820 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
821 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
822 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100823 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100824 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
825 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
826 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
827 "option splice-response".
828
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200829spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900830 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
831 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
832 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
833 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
834 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
835 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200836
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200837tune.bufsize <number>
838 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
839 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
840 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
841 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
842 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
843 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
844 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
845 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400846 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
847 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
848 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200849
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200850tune.chksize <number>
851 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
852 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
853 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
854 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
855 checks whenever possible.
856
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100857tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
858 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
859 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
860 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
861 this value. The default value is 1.
862
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100863tune.http.cookielen <number>
864 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
865 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
866 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
867 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
868 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
869 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
870 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
871 to change this value.
872
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200873tune.http.maxhdr <number>
874 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
875 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
876 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
877 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
878 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
879 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
880 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
881 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
882 limit too high.
883
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100884tune.idletimer <timeout>
885 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
886 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
887 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
888 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
889 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
890 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
891 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
892 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
893 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
894
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100895tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100896 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
897 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
898 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
899 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
900 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
901 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
902 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
903 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
904 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
905 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100906
907tune.maxpollevents <number>
908 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
909 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
910 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
911 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
912 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
913
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200914tune.maxrewrite <number>
915 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
916 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
917 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
918 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
919 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
920 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
921 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
922 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
923 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
924 bufsize.
925
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200926tune.pipesize <number>
927 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
928 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
929 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
930 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
931 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
932 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
933
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100934tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
935tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
936 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
937 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
938 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
939 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
940 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
941 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
942 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
943
944tune.sndbuf.client <number>
945tune.sndbuf.server <number>
946 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
947 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
948 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
949 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
950 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
951 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
952 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
953 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
954 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
955 notifying haproxy again.
956
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100957tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100958 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
959 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
960 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
961 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
962 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
963 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
964 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
965 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
966 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100967 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
968 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100969
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100970tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
971 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
972 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
973 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
974 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
975 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
976 being used for too long.
977
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100978tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
979 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
980 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
981 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
982 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
983 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
984 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
985 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
986 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
987 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
988 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100989 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
990 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100991
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100992tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
993 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
994 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
995 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
996 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
997 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
998
999tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1000 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1001 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1002 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1003 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010053.3. Debugging
1006--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007
1008debug
1009 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1010 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1011 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1012 system startup.
1013
1014quiet
1015 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1016 line argument "-q".
1017
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010193.4. Userlists
1020--------------
1021It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1022http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1023it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1024
1025userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001026 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001027 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1028
1029group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001030 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001031 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1032 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1033
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001034user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1035 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001036 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1037 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001038 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1039 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001040 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
1041 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
1042
1043
1044 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001045 userlist L1
1046 group G1 users tiger,scott
1047 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001048
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001049 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1050 user scott insecure-password elgato
1051 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001052
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001053 userlist L2
1054 group G1
1055 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001056
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001057 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1058 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1059 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001060
1061 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001062
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001063
10643.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001065----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001066It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1067haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1068pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1069identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1070or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1071Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1072known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1073the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1074process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1075during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1076tables.
1077
1078peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001079 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001080 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1081
1082peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1083 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1084 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1085 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1086 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1087 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1088 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1089
1090 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1091 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1092
1093 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1094 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1095 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1096 across all peers.
1097
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001098 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1099 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1100 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1101
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001102 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001103 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001104 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1105 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1106 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001107
1108 backend mybackend
1109 mode tcp
1110 balance roundrobin
1111 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1112 stick on src
1113
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001114 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1115 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001116
1117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011184. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001119----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001121Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1122 - defaults <name>
1123 - frontend <name>
1124 - backend <name>
1125 - listen <name>
1126
1127A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1128its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1129section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001130section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131
1132A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1133connections.
1134
1135A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1136to forward incoming connections.
1137
1138A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1139parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1140
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001141All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1142'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1143case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1144
1145Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1146logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1147proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1148However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1149name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1150
1151Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1152and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001153bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001154protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1155modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1156arbitrary criteria.
1157
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001158In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1159a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1160the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1161
1162 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1163 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1164 between responses and new requests.
1165
1166 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1167 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1168 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1169 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1170
1171 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1172 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1173 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1174
1175 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1176 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1177 client-facing connection remains open.
1178
1179 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1180 after the end of the response.
1181
1182The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1183frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1184following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1185weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1186
1187 Backend mode
1188
1189 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1190 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1191 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1192 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1193 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1194 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1195 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1196 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1197 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1198 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1199 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1200
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001201
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012034.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1204--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001206The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1207limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1208they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1209limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001210marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001211option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001212and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1213with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1214specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001215
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001216
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001217 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1218------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1219acl - X X X
1220appsession - - X X
1221backlog X X X -
1222balance X - X X
1223bind - X X -
1224bind-process X X X X
1225block - X X X
1226capture cookie - X X -
1227capture request header - X X -
1228capture response header - X X -
1229clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001230compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001231contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1232cookie X - X X
1233default-server X - X X
1234default_backend X X X -
1235description - X X X
1236disabled X X X X
1237dispatch - - X X
1238enabled X X X X
1239errorfile X X X X
1240errorloc X X X X
1241errorloc302 X X X X
1242-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1243errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001244force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001245fullconn X - X X
1246grace X X X X
1247hash-type X - X X
1248http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001249http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001250http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001251http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001252http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01001253tcp-check connect - - X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001254tcp-check expect - - X X
1255tcp-check send - - X X
1256tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001257http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001258id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001259ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001260log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001261maxconn X X X -
1262mode X X X X
1263monitor fail - X X -
1264monitor-net X X X -
1265monitor-uri X X X -
1266option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1267option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1268option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1269option allbackups (*) X - X X
1270option checkcache (*) X - X X
1271option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1272option contstats (*) X X X -
1273option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1274option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1275option forceclose (*) X X X X
1276-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1277option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001278option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001279option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001280option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001281option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001282option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001283option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1284option httpchk X - X X
1285option httpclose (*) X X X X
1286option httplog X X X X
1287option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001288option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001289option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001290option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1291option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1292option logasap (*) X X X -
1293option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001294option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001295option nolinger (*) X X X X
1296option originalto X X X X
1297option persist (*) X - X X
1298option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001299option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300option smtpchk X - X X
1301option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1302option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1303option splice-request (*) X X X X
1304option splice-response (*) X X X X
1305option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1306option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1307-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001308option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001309option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1310option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1311option tcpka X X X X
1312option tcplog X X X X
1313option transparent (*) X - X X
1314persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1315rate-limit sessions X X X -
1316redirect - X X X
1317redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1318redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1319reqadd - X X X
1320reqallow - X X X
1321reqdel - X X X
1322reqdeny - X X X
1323reqiallow - X X X
1324reqidel - X X X
1325reqideny - X X X
1326reqipass - X X X
1327reqirep - X X X
1328reqisetbe - X X X
1329reqitarpit - X X X
1330reqpass - X X X
1331reqrep - X X X
1332-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1333reqsetbe - X X X
1334reqtarpit - X X X
1335retries X - X X
1336rspadd - X X X
1337rspdel - X X X
1338rspdeny - X X X
1339rspidel - X X X
1340rspideny - X X X
1341rspirep - X X X
1342rsprep - X X X
1343server - - X X
1344source X - X X
1345srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001346stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001347stats auth X - X X
1348stats enable X - X X
1349stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001350stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001351stats realm X - X X
1352stats refresh X - X X
1353stats scope X - X X
1354stats show-desc X - X X
1355stats show-legends X - X X
1356stats show-node X - X X
1357stats uri X - X X
1358-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1359stick match - - X X
1360stick on - - X X
1361stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001362stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001363stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001364tcp-request connection - X X -
1365tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001366tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001367tcp-response content - - X X
1368tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001369timeout check X - X X
1370timeout client X X X -
1371timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1372timeout connect X - X X
1373timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1374timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1375timeout http-request X X X X
1376timeout queue X - X X
1377timeout server X - X X
1378timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1379timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001380timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001381transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001382unique-id-format X X X -
1383unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001384use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001385use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001386------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1387 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013904.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1391---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001392
1393This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1394
1395
1396acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1397 Declare or complete an access list.
1398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1399 no | yes | yes | yes
1400 Example:
1401 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1402 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1403 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001405 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001406
1407
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001408appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1409 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001410 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1412 no | no | yes | yes
1413 Arguments :
1414 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1415 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1416
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001417 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001418 checked in each cookie value.
1419
1420 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1421 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1422 milliseconds.
1423
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001424 request-learn
1425 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1426 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1427 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1428 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1429 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1430 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1431
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001432 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1433 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1434 data following this prefix.
1435
1436 Example :
1437 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1438
1439 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1440 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1441
1442 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1443 2 modes are currently supported :
1444 - path-parameters :
1445 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1446 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1447 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1448 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1449 - query-string :
1450 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1451 query string.
1452
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001453 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1454 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1455 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1456 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001457 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1458 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1459 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1461 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1462
1463 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1464
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001465 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1466 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1467 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001469 Example :
1470 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1471
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001472 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1473 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474
1475
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001476backlog <conns>
1477 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1479 yes | yes | yes | no
1480 Arguments :
1481 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1482 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001483 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001484
1485 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1486 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1487 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1488 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1489 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1490 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1491 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1492 backlog parameter.
1493
1494 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1495 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1496 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1497
1498 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1499
1500
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001501balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001502balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001503 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1505 yes | no | yes | yes
1506 Arguments :
1507 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1508 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1509 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1510 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1511
1512 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1513 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1514 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1515 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001516 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001517 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001518 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1519 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1520 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1521 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1522 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1523 it, so that you don't worry.
1524
1525 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1526 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1527 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1528 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1529 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1530 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1531 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1532 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001533
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001534 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1535 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1536 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1537 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1538 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1539 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1540 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1541 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1542
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001543 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1544 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1545 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1546 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001547 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001548 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1549 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1550 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1551 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1552 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001553 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1554 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1555 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1556 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1557 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1558 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001559
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001560 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1561 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1562 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1563 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1564 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1565 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1566 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1567 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001568 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001569 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001570 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1571 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1572 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001573
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001574 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1575 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1576 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1577 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1578 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1579 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1580 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1581 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1582 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1583 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1584 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1585 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001586
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001587 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001588 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1589 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1590 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1591 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1592 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1593 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1594 URIs start with a leading "/".
1595
1596 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1597 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1598 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1599 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1600
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001601 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001602 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1603
1604 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001605 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1606 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1607 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1608 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1609 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1610 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1611 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1612 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1613 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1614 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1615 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1616 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1617 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1618 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1619 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1620 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1621 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1622 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1623 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001624
1625 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1626 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1627 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1628 server will receive the request.
1629
1630 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1631 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1632 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1633 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1634 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001635 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1636 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1637 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001638
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001639 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1640 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1641 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1642 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1643 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001645 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001646 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1647 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1648 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1649
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001650 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1651 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1652 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1653
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001654 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001655 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001656 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1657 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1658 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1659 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1660 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1661 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001662 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001663 used instead.
1664
1665 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1666 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1667 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1668 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1669
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001670 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1671 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1672 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1673
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001674 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001676 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001677 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1678 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001679
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001680 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001681 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001683 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1684 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1685 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686
1687 Examples :
1688 balance roundrobin
1689 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001690 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001691 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1692 balance hdr(host)
1693 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001694
1695 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1696 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001698 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001699 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1700 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1701 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1702 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1703
1704 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1705 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1706 defaults to 16 kB.
1707
1708 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1709 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1710
1711 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1712 Round Robin.
1713
1714 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1715 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1716 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1717 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1718
1719 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1720
1721 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001722 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001723 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1724 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1725 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001727 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1728 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001729
1730
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001731bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1732bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1735 no | yes | yes | no
1736 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001737 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1738 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1739 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1740 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001741 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001742 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1743 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1744 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1745 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1746 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1747 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1748 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001749 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1750 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1751 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001752 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1753 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1754 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1755 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001756
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001757 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1758 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001759 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1760 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1761 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001762 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1763 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1764 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1765 the range.
1766
1767 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1768 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1769 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1770 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1771 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1772 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1773 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001774 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001775 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001776
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001777 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1778 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1779 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1780 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1781 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1782 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1783 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1784 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1785
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001786 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1787 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1788 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1789 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001791 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1792 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1793 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1794 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1795 in a frontend.
1796
1797 Example :
1798 listen http_proxy
1799 bind :80,:443
1800 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001801 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001802
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001803 listen http_https_proxy
1804 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001805 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001806
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001807 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1808 bind ipv6@:80
1809 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1810 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1811
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001812 listen external_bind_app1
1813 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1814
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001815 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001816 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001817
1818
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001819bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001820 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1822 yes | yes | yes | yes
1823 Arguments :
1824 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1825 may be used to override a default value.
1826
1827 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1828 option may be combined with other numbers.
1829
1830 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1831 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1832 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1833 missing from all processes.
1834
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001835 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1836 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1837 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1838 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1839 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001840
1841 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1842 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1843 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1844 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1845 and 'even' instances.
1846
1847 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1848 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1849 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1850 32.
1851
1852 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1853 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1854
1855 Example :
1856 listen app_ip1
1857 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001858 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001859
1860 listen app_ip2
1861 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001862 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001863
1864 listen management
1865 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001866 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001867
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001868 listen management
1869 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1870 bind-process 1-4
1871
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001872 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1873
1874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001875block { if | unless } <condition>
1876 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1878 no | yes | yes | yes
1879
1880 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1881 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001882 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001883 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1885 "block" statements per instance.
1886
1887 Example:
1888 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1889 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1890 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1891 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001893 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894
1895
1896capture cookie <name> len <length>
1897 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1899 no | yes | yes | no
1900 Arguments :
1901 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1902 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1903 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1904 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1905 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1906
1907 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1908 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1909 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1910 right if it exceeds <length>.
1911
1912 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1913 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1914 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1915 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1916
1917 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1918 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1919 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1920
1921 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1922 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1923 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001924 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1925 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1926 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001927
1928 Example:
1929 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1930
1931 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001932 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001933
1934
1935capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001936 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1938 no | yes | yes | no
1939 Arguments :
1940 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001941 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001942 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1943 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1944 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1945
1946 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1947 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1948 it exceeds <length>.
1949
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001950 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001951 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1952 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001953 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1954 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1955 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1956 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001957 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001958 environments to find where the request came from.
1959
1960 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1961 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1962 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1963 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001964
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001965 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1966 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1967 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1968 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1969 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001970
1971 Example:
1972 capture request header Host len 15
1973 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1974 capture request header Referrer len 15
1975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001976 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001977 about logging.
1978
1979
1980capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001981 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1983 no | yes | yes | no
1984 Arguments :
1985 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001986 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1988 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1989 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1990
1991 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1992 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1993 it exceeds <length>.
1994
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001995 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001996 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1997 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1998 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001999 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2000 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2001 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2002 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002003
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002004 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2005 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2006 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2007 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2008 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002009
2010 Example:
2011 capture response header Content-length len 9
2012 capture response header Location len 15
2013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002014 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002015 about logging.
2016
2017
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002018clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2021 yes | yes | yes | no
2022 Arguments :
2023 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2024 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2025 as explained at the top of this document.
2026
2027 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2028 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2029 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2030 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2031 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2032 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2033 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2034 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002035 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002036 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2037 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2038
2039 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2040 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2041 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2042 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2043 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2044 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2045
2046 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2047 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2048
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002049 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2050 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002051
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002052compression algo <algorithm> ...
2053compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002054compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002055 Enable HTTP compression.
2056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2057 yes | yes | yes | yes
2058 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002059 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2060 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2061 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2062
2063 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002064 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002065 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2066 data.
2067
2068 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2069 support for zlib was built in.
2070
2071 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2072 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2073 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2074 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2075 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2076 in.
2077
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002078 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002079 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002080 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2081 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2082 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2083 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2084 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002085
2086 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2087 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2088 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2089 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2090 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002091 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2092 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2093 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2094 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2095 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2096 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002097
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002098 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002099 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2100 "Accept-Encoding" header
2101 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002102 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002103 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2104 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002105 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2106 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2107 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2108 "multipart"
2109 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2110 header
2111 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2112 and later
2113 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2114 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002115
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002116 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2117 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002118
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002119 Examples :
2120 compression algo gzip
2121 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002122
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002123contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002124 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2126 yes | no | yes | yes
2127 Arguments :
2128 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2129 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2130 as explained at the top of this document.
2131
2132 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002133 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002134 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002135 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2136 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2137 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2138 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2139
2140 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2141 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2142 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2143 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2144 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2145 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2146
2147 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2148 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2149 instead.
2150
2151 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2152 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2153
2154
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002155cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002156 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2157 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2160 yes | no | yes | yes
2161 Arguments :
2162 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2163 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2164 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2165 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2166 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2167 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2168 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2169 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2170 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2171
2172 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2173 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2174 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2175 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2176 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2177 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2178 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2179 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2180 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2181 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2182 "insert" and "prefix".
2183
2184 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002185 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002186
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002187 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002188 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2189 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2190 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2191 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2192 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2193 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2194 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2195 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2196 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2197 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
2199 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2200 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2201 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2202 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2203 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2204 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2205 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2206 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2207 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2208 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002209 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2210 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2211 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002212
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002213 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2214 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2215 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002216 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2217 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2218 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2219 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002220 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2221 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2222 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223
2224 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2225 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2226 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2227 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2228 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2229 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2230 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2231 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2232 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2233
2234 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2235 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2236 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2237 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2238 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2239 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2240 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2241 persistence cookie in the cache.
2242 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2243
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002244 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2245 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2246 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2247 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2248 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2249 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2250 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2251 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2252 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2253 they logout.
2254
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002255 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2256 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2257 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2258 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2259
2260 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2261 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2262 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2263 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2264 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2265 this attribute.
2266
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002267 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002268 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002269 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2270 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2271 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2272 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2273 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2274 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002275
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002276 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2277 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2278 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2279 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2280 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2281 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2282 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2283 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2284 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2285 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2286 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2287 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2288 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2289 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2290 the site.
2291
2292 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2293 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2294 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2295 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2296 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2297 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2298 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2299 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2300 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2301 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2302 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2303 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2304 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2305 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2306 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2307 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2308
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2310 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2311 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2312 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002313
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002314 Examples :
2315 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2316 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2317 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002318 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002319
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002320 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002321 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002322
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002323
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002324default-server [param*]
2325 Change default options for a server in a backend
2326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2327 yes | no | yes | yes
2328 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002329 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2330 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2331 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2332 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002333
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002334 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002335 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2336
2337 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002338
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002340default_backend <backend>
2341 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2343 yes | yes | yes | no
2344 Arguments :
2345 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2346
2347 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2348 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2349 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2350 will catch all undetermined requests.
2351
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352 Example :
2353
2354 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2355 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2356 default_backend dynamic
2357
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002358 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002360
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002361description <string>
2362 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2364 no | yes | yes | yes
2365 Arguments : string
2366
2367 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2368 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2369 it describes.
2370 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2371
2372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002373disabled
2374 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2376 yes | yes | yes | yes
2377 Arguments : none
2378
2379 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2380 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2381 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2382 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2383 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2384 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2385 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2386
2387 See also : "enabled"
2388
2389
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002390dispatch <address>:<port>
2391 Set a default server address
2392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2393 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002394 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002395
2396 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2397 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2398 during start-up.
2399
2400 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2401 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2402 possible with normal servers.
2403
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002404 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002405 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2406 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2407 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2408 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2409
2410 See also : "server"
2411
2412
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002413enabled
2414 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2416 yes | yes | yes | yes
2417 Arguments : none
2418
2419 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2420 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2421
2422 See also : "disabled"
2423
2424
2425errorfile <code> <file>
2426 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2428 yes | yes | yes | yes
2429 Arguments :
2430 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002431 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002432
2433 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002434 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002435 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002436 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2437 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002438
2439 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2440 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2441 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2442
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002443 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2444
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002445 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2446 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2447 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2448 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2449
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002450 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2451 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2452 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2453 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2454 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2455 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2456
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2458 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2459 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002460 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2462
2463 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2464
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002465 Example :
2466 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2467 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2468 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2469
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002470
2471errorloc <code> <url>
2472errorloc302 <code> <url>
2473 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2475 yes | yes | yes | yes
2476 Arguments :
2477 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002478 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002479
2480 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2481 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2482 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2483 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2484 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2485
2486 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2487 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2488 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2489
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002490 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2491
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002492 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2493 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2494 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2495 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2496 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2497 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2498 request.
2499
2500 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2501
2502
2503errorloc303 <code> <url>
2504 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2506 yes | yes | yes | yes
2507 Arguments :
2508 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2509 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2510
2511 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2512 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2513 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2514 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2515 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2516
2517 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2518 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2519 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2520
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002521 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2522
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002523 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2524 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2525 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2526 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002527 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002528
2529 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2530
2531
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002532force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2533 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2535 no | yes | yes | yes
2536
2537 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2538 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2539 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2540 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2541 marked down for maintenance operations.
2542
2543 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2544 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2545 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2546 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2547 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2548 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2549 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2550 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2551 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2552
2553 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2554 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2555 is used.
2556
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002557 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002558 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002559
2560
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002561fullconn <conns>
2562 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2564 yes | no | yes | yes
2565 Arguments :
2566 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2567 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2568
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002569 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002570 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002571 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002572 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2573 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2574 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2575 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2576 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002577 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002578
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002579 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2580 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2581 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2582
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002583 Example :
2584 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2585 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2586 # connections.
2587 backend dynamic
2588 fullconn 10000
2589 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2590 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2591
2592 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2593
2594
2595grace <time>
2596 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002598 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002599 Arguments :
2600 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2601 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2602 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2603
2604 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2605 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002606 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002607 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2608
2609 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2610 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2611 simplify it.
2612
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002613
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002614hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002615 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2617 yes | no | yes | yes
2618 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002619 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2620 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002621
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002622 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2623 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2624 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2625 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2626 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2627 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2628 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2629 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2630 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2631 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002632
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002633 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2634 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2635 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2636 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2637 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2638 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2639 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2640 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2641 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2642 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2643 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2644 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2645 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002646 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2647 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002648
2649 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2650
2651 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2652 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2653 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2654 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002655 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2656 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2657 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002658
2659 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2660 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002661 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2662 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2663 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2664 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2665
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002666 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2667 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2668 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2669 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2670 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2671 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2672 parameter.
2673
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002674 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2675
2676 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2677 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2678 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2679 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2680 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2681 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2682 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2683 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2684 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2685 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2686 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2687 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002688
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002689 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2690 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2691 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002692
2693 See also : "balance", "server"
2694
2695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002696http-check disable-on-404
2697 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002699 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700 Arguments : none
2701
2702 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2703 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2704 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2705 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2706 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2707 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2708 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2709 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002710 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2711 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2712 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2713
2714 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2715
2716
2717http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002718 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002720 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002721 Arguments :
2722 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2723 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002724 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002725 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2726 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2727 details on the supported keywords.
2728
2729 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2730 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2731 with the usual backslash ('\').
2732
2733 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2734 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2735 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2736 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2737 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2738
2739 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002740 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002741 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2742 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2743 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2744
2745 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002746 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002747 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2748 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2749 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2750 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2751
2752 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002753 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002754 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2755 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2756 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2757 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2758 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2759 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2760 trace).
2761
2762 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002763 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002764 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2765 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2766 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2767 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2768 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2769 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2770
2771 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2772 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2773 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2774 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2775 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2776 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2777 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2778 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2779
2780 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2781 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2782
2783 Examples :
2784 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002785 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002786
2787 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002788 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002789
2790 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002791 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002792
2793 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002794 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002795
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002796 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002797
2798
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002799http-check send-state
2800 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2802 yes | no | yes | yes
2803 Arguments : none
2804
2805 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2806 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2807 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2808 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2809 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2810
2811 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2812 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2813 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2814 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2815 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2816 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2817 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2818 checked in multiple backends.
2819
2820 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2821 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2822
2823 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2824 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2825 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2826 one fails.
2827
2828 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2829 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2830 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2831
2832 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2833 server's queue.
2834
2835 Example of a header received by the application server :
2836 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2837 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2838
2839 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2840
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002841http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002842 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002843 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2844 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002845 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002846 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2847
2848 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2849 no | yes | yes | yes
2850
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002851 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2852 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2853 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2854 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2855 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002856
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002857 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2858 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2859 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2860
2861 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2862 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2863 are evaluated.
2864
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002865 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2866 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2867 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2868 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2869 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2870 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2871 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2872 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2873 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2874 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2875 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2876
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002877 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2878 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2879 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2880 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2881 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2882
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002883 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2884 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2885 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002886 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2887 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002888
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002889 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2890 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2891 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2892 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2893 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2894 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2895 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2896 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2897
2898 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2899 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2900 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2901 external users.
2902
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002903 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2904 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2905 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2906 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2907 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2908 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2909 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2910 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2911
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002912 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2913 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2914 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2915 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2916 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2917 another equipment.
2918
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002919 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2920 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2921 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2922 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2923 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2924 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2925 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2926 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2927
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002928 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2929 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2930 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2931 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2932 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2933 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2934 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2935 admin privileges.
2936
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002937 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2938
2939 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2940 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2941 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2942 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002943
2944 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002945 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2946 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2947 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002948
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002949 http-request allow if nagios
2950 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2951 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2952 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002953
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002954 Example:
2955 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002956 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002957
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002958 Example:
2959 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2960 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2961 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2962 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2963 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2964 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2965 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2966 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2967 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2968
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002969 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2970 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002971
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002972http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002973 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002974 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2975 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002976 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2977
2978 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2979 no | yes | yes | yes
2980
2981 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2982 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2983 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2984 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2985 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2986 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2987
2988 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2989 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2990 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2991 current section.
2992
2993 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2994 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2995 rules are evaluated.
2996
2997 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2998 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2999 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3000 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3001 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3002 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3003 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3004
3005 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3006 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3007 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3008 external users.
3009
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003010 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3011 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3012 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3013 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3014 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3015 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3016 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3017 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3018
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003019 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3020 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3021 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3022 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3023 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3024 another equipment.
3025
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003026 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3027 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3028 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3029 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3030 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3031 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3032 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3033 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3034
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003035 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3036 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3037 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3038 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3039 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3040 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3041 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3042 admin privileges.
3043
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003044 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3045
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003046 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003047 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3048 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3049 rules.
3050
3051 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3052 ACL usage.
3053
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003054
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003055tcp-check connect [params*]
3056 Opens a new connection
3057 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3058 no | no | yes | yes
3059
3060 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
3061 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
3062 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
3063
3064 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
3065 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
3066 of the sequence.
3067
3068 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
3069 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
3070 do.
3071
3072 Parameters :
3073 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
3074 use the TCP connection.
3075
3076 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
3077 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
3078 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
3079
3080 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
3081
3082 ssl opens a ciphered connection
3083
3084 Examples:
3085 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
3086 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
3087 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
3088 option tcp-check
3089 tcp-check connect
3090 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
3091 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
3092 tcp-check send \r\n
3093 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
3094 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
3095 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
3096 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
3097 tcp-check send \r\n
3098 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
3099 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
3100
3101 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
3102 option tcp-check
3103 tcp-check connect port 110
3104 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3105 tcp-check connect port 143
3106 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3107 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
3108
3109 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
3110
3111
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003112tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
3113 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
3114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3115 no | no | yes | yes
3116
3117 Arguments :
3118 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3119 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
3120 binary.
3121 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
3122 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
3123 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
3124
3125 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3126 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3127 with the usual backslash ('\').
3128 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
3129 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
3130 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
3131 used upper or lower case.
3132
3133
3134 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
3135
3136 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
3137 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3138 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
3139 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3140 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3141 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
3142 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
3143 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
3144
3145 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
3146 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3147 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
3148 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3149 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
3150 expression.
3151
3152 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
3153 in the response buffer. A health check response will
3154 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
3155 this exact hexadecimal string.
3156 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
3157
3158 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3159 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3160 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3161 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
3162 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3163 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3164 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3165 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3166 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3167 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3168 the null character.
3169
3170 Examples :
3171 # perform a POP check
3172 option tcp-check
3173 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3174
3175 # perform an IMAP check
3176 option tcp-check
3177 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3178
3179 # look for the redis master server
3180 option tcp-check
3181 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3182 tcp-check expect +PONG
3183 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3184 tcp-check expect string role:master
3185 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3186 tcp-check expect string +OK
3187
3188
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003189 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
3190 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003191
3192
3193tcp-check send <data>
3194 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3195 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3196 no | no | yes | yes
3197
3198 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3199 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3200
3201 Examples :
3202 # look for the redis master server
3203 option tcp-check
3204 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3205 tcp-check expect string role:master
3206
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003207 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
3208 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003209
3210
3211tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3212 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3213 tcp health check
3214 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3215 no | no | yes | yes
3216
3217 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3218 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3219 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3220 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3221 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3222 hexadecimal string.
3223 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3224
3225 Examples :
3226 # redis check in binary
3227 option tcp-check
3228 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3229 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3230
3231
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003232 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
3233 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003234
3235
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003236http-send-name-header [<header>]
3237 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3238
3239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | no | yes | yes
3241
3242 Arguments :
3243
3244 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3245
3246 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3247 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3248 is added with the header string proved.
3249
3250 See also : "server"
3251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003252id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003253 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3255 no | yes | yes | yes
3256 Arguments : none
3257
3258 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3259 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3260 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003261
3262
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003263ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3264 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3266 no | yes | yes | yes
3267
3268 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3269 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3270 and running).
3271
3272 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3273 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3274 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3275 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3276 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3277
3278 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3279 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3280
3281 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3282 "unless" condition is met.
3283
3284 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3285
3286
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003287log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003288log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003289no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003290 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3292 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003293
3294 Prefix :
3295 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3296 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3297 prefix does not allow arguments.
3298
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003299 Arguments :
3300 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3301 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3302 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3303 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3304 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3305 parameter.
3306
3307 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3308 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3309
3310 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3311 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3312 standard syslog port).
3313
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003314 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3315 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3316 standard syslog port).
3317
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003318 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3319 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3320 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3321 appropriately writeable).
3322
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003323 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3324 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3325 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3326 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3327
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003328 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3329
3330 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3331 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3332 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3333
3334 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3335 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3336 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003337 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3338 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3339 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3340 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3341 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003342
3343 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3344
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003345 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3346 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3347 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003348
3349 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3350 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3351 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3352 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3353
3354 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3355 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003356
3357 Example :
3358 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003359 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3360 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003361 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3362
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003363
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003364log-format <string>
3365 Allows you to custom a log line.
3366
3367 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3368
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003369
3370maxconn <conns>
3371 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 yes | yes | yes | no
3374 Arguments :
3375 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3376 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3377 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3378 closes.
3379
3380 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3381 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3382 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3383 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3384 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3385 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3386 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3387 properly tuned.
3388
3389 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3390 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3391 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3392
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003393 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3394
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003395 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3396
3397
3398mode { tcp|http|health }
3399 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 yes | yes | yes | yes
3402 Arguments :
3403 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3404 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3405 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3406 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3407
3408 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3409 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3410 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3411 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3412 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3413
3414 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003415 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3416 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3417 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3418 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3419 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3420 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3421 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003422
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003423 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3424 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3425 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003426
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003427 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003428 defaults http_instances
3429 mode http
3430
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003431 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003434monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003435 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3437 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003438 Arguments :
3439 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3440 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003441 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003442 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3443 backend and its backup.
3444
3445 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3446 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3447 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3448 servers in a list of backends.
3449
3450 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3451 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3452 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3453 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3454 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3455 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3456 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003457 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3458 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459
3460 Example:
3461 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003462 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3464 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3465 monitor-uri /site_alive
3466 monitor fail if site_dead
3467
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003468 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003469
3470
3471monitor-net <source>
3472 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3474 yes | yes | yes | no
3475 Arguments :
3476 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3477 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3478 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3479 followed by a mask.
3480
3481 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3482 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003483 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003484 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3485
3486 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3487 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3488 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3489 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003490 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3491 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3492 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003493
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003494 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3495 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3496 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3497 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3498 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3499 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003500
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003501 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3502 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003504 Example :
3505 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3506 frontend www
3507 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3508
3509 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3510
3511
3512monitor-uri <uri>
3513 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3515 yes | yes | yes | no
3516 Arguments :
3517 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3518 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3519
3520 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3521 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3522 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3523 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3524 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3525 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3526 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3527 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3528
3529 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3530 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3531 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3532 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3533 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3534 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3535
3536 Example :
3537 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3538 frontend www
3539 mode http
3540 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3541
3542 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3543
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003544
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003545option abortonclose
3546no option abortonclose
3547 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3549 yes | no | yes | yes
3550 Arguments : none
3551
3552 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3553 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3554 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3555 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003556 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003557 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3558 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3559 encountered while delivering the response.
3560
3561 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3562 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3563 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3564 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3565 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3566 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003567 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003568 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003569 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003570 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3571 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3572 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3573
3574 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3575 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3576 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3577 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3578 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3579 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3580 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3581 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003582 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003583
3584 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3585 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3586
3587 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3588
3589
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003590option accept-invalid-http-request
3591no option accept-invalid-http-request
3592 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3594 yes | yes | yes | no
3595 Arguments : none
3596
3597 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3598 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3599 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3600 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3601 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3602 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3603 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3604 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003605 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3606 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3607 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3608 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3609 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3610 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003611
3612 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3613 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3614 been confirmed.
3615
3616 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3617 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003618 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3619 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003620 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3621
3622 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3623 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3624
3625 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3626 stats socket.
3627
3628
3629option accept-invalid-http-response
3630no option accept-invalid-http-response
3631 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3633 yes | no | yes | yes
3634 Arguments : none
3635
3636 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3637 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3638 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3639 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3640 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3641 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3642 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3643 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3644 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3645
3646 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3647 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3648 been confirmed.
3649
3650 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3651 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3652 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3653 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3654
3655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3657
3658 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3659 stats socket.
3660
3661
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003662option allbackups
3663no option allbackups
3664 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 yes | no | yes | yes
3667 Arguments : none
3668
3669 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3670 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3671 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3672 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3673 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3674 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3675 order between the backup servers anymore.
3676
3677 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3678 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3679
3680 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3681 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3682
3683
3684option checkcache
3685no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003686 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3688 yes | no | yes | yes
3689 Arguments : none
3690
3691 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3692 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003693 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003694 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3695 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003696 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003697
3698 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003699 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003700 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003701 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3702 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003703 to the client are :
3704 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003705 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003706 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003707 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3708 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3709 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3710 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3711 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3712 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3713 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3714 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3715 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3716 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3717 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3718
3719 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003720 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003721 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003722 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003723 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3724
3725 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3726 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003727 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003728 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3729
3730 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3731 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3732
3733
3734option clitcpka
3735no option clitcpka
3736 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3738 yes | yes | yes | no
3739 Arguments : none
3740
3741 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3742 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3743 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3744 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3745
3746 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3747 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3748 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3749 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3750
3751 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3752 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3753 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3754 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3755 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3756
3757 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3758
3759 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3760 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3761 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3762
3763 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3764 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3765
3766 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3767
3768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003769option contstats
3770 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3772 yes | yes | yes | no
3773 Arguments : none
3774
3775 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3776 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3777 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3778 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3779 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3780 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3781 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3782
3783
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003784option dontlog-normal
3785no option dontlog-normal
3786 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3788 yes | yes | yes | no
3789 Arguments : none
3790
3791 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3792 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3793 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3794 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3795 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3796 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3797 logged.
3798
3799 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3800 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3801 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003803 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003804 logging.
3805
3806
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003807option dontlognull
3808no option dontlognull
3809 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3811 yes | yes | yes | no
3812 Arguments : none
3813
3814 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3815 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3816 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3817 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3818 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3819 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3820 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3821
3822 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3823 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3824 would not be logged.
3825
3826 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3827 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003829 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003830
3831
3832option forceclose
3833no option forceclose
3834 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003836 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003837 Arguments : none
3838
3839 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3840 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3841 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3842 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3843 global session times in the logs.
3844
3845 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003846 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003847 to respond and release some resources earlier than with 'option httpclose'.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003848
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003849 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3850 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3851 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3852
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003853 This option disables and replaces any previous 'option httpclose', 'option
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003854 http-server-close', 'option http-keep-alive', or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003855
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003856 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3857 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3858
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003859 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003860
3861
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003862option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003863 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3865 yes | yes | yes | yes
3866 Arguments :
3867 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3868 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003869 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003870 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003871
3872 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3873 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3874 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3875 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3876 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3877 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3878 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003879 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3880 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3881 possible that the client has already brought one.
3882
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003883 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003884 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003885 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3886 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003887 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3888 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003889
3890 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3891 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3892 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3893 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3894 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3895 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3896 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3897
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003898 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3899 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3900 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3901 are under the control of the end-user.
3902
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003903 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003904 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3905 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003906 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3907 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3908 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003909
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003910 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003911 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3912 frontend www
3913 mode http
3914 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3915
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003916 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3917 backend www
3918 mode http
3919 option forwardfor header X-Client
3920
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003921 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003922 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003923
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003924
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003925option http-keep-alive
3926no option http-keep-alive
3927 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 yes | yes | yes | yes
3930 Arguments : none
3931
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003932 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3933 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3934 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3935 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3936 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3937 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3938 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3939
3940 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3941 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003942 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3943 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3944 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3945 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3946 situations where this option may be useful :
3947
3948 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3949 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3950
3951 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3952 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3953
3954 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3955 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3956 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3957 request.
3958
3959 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3960 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003961 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3962 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3963 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003964
3965 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3966 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3967
3968 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3969 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3970 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3971 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3972 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3973 not set.
3974
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003975 This option disables and replaces any previous 'option httpclose', 'option
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003976 http-server-close', 'option forceclose' or "option http-tunnel". When backend
3977 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
3978 'option http-keep-alive'.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003979
3980 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003981 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3982 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003983
3984
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003985option http-no-delay
3986no option http-no-delay
3987 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3989 yes | yes | yes | yes
3990 Arguments : none
3991
3992 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3993 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3994 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3995 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3996 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3997 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3998 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3999 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4000 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4001 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4002 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4003 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4004 affected.
4005
4006 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4007 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4008 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4009 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4010 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4011 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4012 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4013 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4014 latency environments.
4015
4016
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004017option http-pretend-keepalive
4018no option http-pretend-keepalive
4019 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4021 yes | yes | yes | yes
4022 Arguments : none
4023
4024 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4025 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4026 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4027 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4028 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4029 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4030 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4031 consider the response complete.
4032
4033 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4034 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4035 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4036 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4037 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4038 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4039
4040 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4041 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4042 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4043 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4044 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4045 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4046 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4047
4048 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4049 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004050 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004051 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4052 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004053
4054 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4055 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4056
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004057 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4058 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004059
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004060
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004061option http-server-close
4062no option http-server-close
4063 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4065 yes | yes | yes | yes
4066 Arguments : none
4067
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004068 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4069 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4070 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4071 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4072 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4073 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4074 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4075 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4076 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4077 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4078 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4079 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4080 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4081 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4082 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4083 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004084
4085 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4086 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4087 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4088 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004089 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4090 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004091
4092 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4093 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004094 It disables and replaces any previous 'option httpclose', 'option forceclose',
4095 'option http-tunnel' or 'option http-keep-alive'. Please check section 4
4096 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4097 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004098
4099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4101
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004102 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004103 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4104 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004105
4106
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004107option http-tunnel
4108no option http-tunnel
4109 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4111 yes | yes | yes | yes
4112 Arguments : none
4113
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004114 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4115 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4116 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4117 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4118 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4119 "option http-tunnel".
4120
4121 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
4122 the first respones. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
4123 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4124 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4125 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4126 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4127 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4128 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4129 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004130
4131 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4132 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4133
4134 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4135 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4136 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4137
4138
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004139option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004140no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004141 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4143 yes | yes | yes | no
4144 Arguments : none
4145
4146 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4147 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4148 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4149 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4150 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4151 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4152 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4153
4154 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4155 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4156 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4157 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4158 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4159 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4160 request along its whole life.
4161
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004162 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4163 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4164 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4165 front of an existing proxy.
4166
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004167 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4168
4169 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4170 http-server-close".
4171
4172
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004173option httpchk
4174option httpchk <uri>
4175option httpchk <method> <uri>
4176option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4177 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4179 yes | no | yes | yes
4180 Arguments :
4181 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4182 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4183 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4184 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4185 ones.
4186
4187 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4188 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4189 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4190
4191 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4192 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4193 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4194 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4195 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4196
4197 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4198 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4199 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4200 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4201 the lack of any response.
4202
4203 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4204
4205 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4206 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4207 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4208
4209 Examples :
4210 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4211 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4212 backend https_relay
4213 mode tcp
4214 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4215 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4216
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004217 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4218 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4219 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004220
4221
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004222option httpclose
4223no option httpclose
4224 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4226 yes | yes | yes | yes
4227 Arguments : none
4228
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004229 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4230 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4231 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4232 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4233 as "option http-serve-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4234 "option http-tunnel".
4235
4236 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4237 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4238 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4239 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4240 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4241 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4242 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4243 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004244
4245 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004246 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004247 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4248 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4249 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4250 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4251 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004252
4253 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4254 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004255 It disables and replaces any previous 'option http-server-close',
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004256 'option forceclose', 'option http-keep-alive' or "option http-tunnel". Please
4257 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4258 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004259
4260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4262
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004263 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4264 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004265
4266
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004267option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004268 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4270 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004271 Arguments :
4272 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4273 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4274 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4275 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4276 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004277
4278 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4279 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4280 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4281 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4282 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4283 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4284 ports.
4285
4286 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4287
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4290 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4291 by default.
4292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004293 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004294
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004295
4296option http_proxy
4297no option http_proxy
4298 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4300 yes | yes | yes | yes
4301 Arguments : none
4302
4303 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4304 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4305 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4306 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4307 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4308
4309 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4310 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4311 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4312 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004313 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004314 be analyzed.
4315
4316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4318
4319 Example :
4320 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4321 backend direct_forward
4322 option httpclose
4323 option http_proxy
4324
4325 See also : "option httpclose"
4326
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004327
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004328option independent-streams
4329no option independent-streams
4330 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4332 yes | yes | yes | yes
4333 Arguments : none
4334
4335 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4336 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4337 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4338 receive data or not.
4339
4340 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4341 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4342 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4343 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4344 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4345 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4346 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4347 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4348 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4349 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4350 socket buffers.
4351
4352 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4353 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4354 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4355 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4356 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4357
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004358 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
4359 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4360 deprecated.
4361
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004362 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004363
4364
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004365option ldap-check
4366 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4368 yes | no | yes | yes
4369 Arguments : none
4370
4371 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4372 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4373 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4374 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4375
4376 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4377 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4378
4379 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4380 configure it.
4381
4382 Example :
4383 option ldap-check
4384
4385 See also : "option httpchk"
4386
4387
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004388option log-health-checks
4389no option log-health-checks
4390 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4392 yes | no | yes | yes
4393 Arguments : none
4394
4395 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4396 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4397 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4398 of additional information is limited.
4399
4400 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4401 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4402
4403 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4404
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004405
4406option log-separate-errors
4407no option log-separate-errors
4408 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 yes | yes | yes | no
4411 Arguments : none
4412
4413 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4414 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4415 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4416 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4417 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4418 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4419 provides very important information.
4420
4421 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4422 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4423 error logs.
4424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004425 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004426 logging.
4427
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004428
4429option logasap
4430no option logasap
4431 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4433 yes | yes | yes | no
4434 Arguments : none
4435
4436 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4437 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4438 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4439 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4440 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4441 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4442 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004443 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004444 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4445 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4446
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004447 Examples :
4448 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4449 mode http
4450 option httplog
4451 option logasap
4452 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4453
4454 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4455 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4456 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4457 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004459 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004460 logging.
4461
4462
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004463option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4464 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4466 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004467 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004468 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4469 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004470
4471 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4472 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4473 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4474 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4475 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4476 in the MySQL table, like this :
4477
4478 USE mysql;
4479 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4480 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4481
4482 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4483 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4484 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4485 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4486 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4487 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4488 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4489 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4490 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4491
4492 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4493 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004494
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004495 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004496
4497 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4498 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4499 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4500 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4501 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4502 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4503
4504 See also: "option httpchk"
4505
4506
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004507option nolinger
4508no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004509 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004510 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4511 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004512 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004513
4514 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4515 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4516 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4517 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4518 connections.
4519
4520 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4521 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4522 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4523 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4524 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4525 this too.
4526
4527 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4528 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4529 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4530
4531 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4532 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4533 for servers.
4534
4535 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4536 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4537
4538
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004539option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4540 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4542 yes | yes | yes | yes
4543 Arguments :
4544 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4545 matching <network>
4546 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4547 header name.
4548
4549 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4550 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4551 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4552 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4553 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4554 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4555 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4556 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4557 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4558 possible that the client has already brought one.
4559
4560 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4561 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4562 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4563 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4564 header and requires different one.
4565
4566 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4567 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4568 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4569 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4570 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4571 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4572 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4573
4574 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4575 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4576 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4577 both are defined.
4578
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004579 Examples :
4580 # Original Destination address
4581 frontend www
4582 mode http
4583 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4584
4585 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4586 backend www
4587 mode http
4588 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4589
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004590 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4591 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004592
4593
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004594option persist
4595no option persist
4596 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4598 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004599 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004600
4601 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4602 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4603 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4604 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4605 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4606 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4607 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4608 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4609 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4610 redirected to another valid server.
4611
4612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4614
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004615 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004616
4617
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004618option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4619 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4621 yes | no | yes | yes
4622 Arguments :
4623 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4624 PostgreSQL server.
4625
4626 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4627 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4628 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4629 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4630
4631 See also: "option httpchk"
4632
4633
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004634option prefer-last-server
4635no option prefer-last-server
4636 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4637 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4638 yes | no | yes | yes
4639 Arguments : none
4640
4641 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4642 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4643 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4644 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4645 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4646 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4647 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4648 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4649 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004650 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4651 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4652 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4653 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4654 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4655 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4656 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004657
4658 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4659 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4660
4661 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4662
4663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004664option redispatch
4665no option redispatch
4666 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4668 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004669 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004670
4671 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4672 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4673 be able to access the service anymore.
4674
4675 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4676 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4677
4678 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4679 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4680 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004682 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4683 "redisp" keywords.
4684
4685 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4686 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4687
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004688 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004689
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004690
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004691option redis-check
4692 Use redis health checks for server testing
4693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4694 yes | no | yes | yes
4695 Arguments : none
4696
4697 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4698 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4699 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4700 find the "+PONG" response message.
4701
4702 Example :
4703 option redis-check
4704
4705 See also : "option httpchk"
4706
4707
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004708option smtpchk
4709option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4710 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4712 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004713 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004714 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4715 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4716 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4717
4718 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4719 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4720 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4721
4722 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4723 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4724 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4725 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4726 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4727 dead server.
4728
4729 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4730 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4731 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4732 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4733
4734 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4735 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4736 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4737 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4738 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4739
4740 Example :
4741 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4742
4743 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004746option socket-stats
4747no option socket-stats
4748
4749 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | yes | yes | no
4752
4753 Arguments : none
4754
4755
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004756option splice-auto
4757no option splice-auto
4758 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4760 yes | yes | yes | yes
4761 Arguments : none
4762
4763 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4764 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4765 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4766 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004767 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004768 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4769 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4770 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4771 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4772
4773 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4774 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4775 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4776 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4777 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4778 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4779 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4780 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4781 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4782 keyword.
4783
4784 Example :
4785 option splice-auto
4786
4787 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4788 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4789
4790 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4791 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4792
4793
4794option splice-request
4795no option splice-request
4796 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4798 yes | yes | yes | yes
4799 Arguments : none
4800
4801 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004802 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004803 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4804 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4805 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4806 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4807
4808 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4809
4810 Example :
4811 option splice-request
4812
4813 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4814 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4815
4816 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4817 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4818
4819
4820option splice-response
4821no option splice-response
4822 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 yes | yes | yes | yes
4825 Arguments : none
4826
4827 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004828 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004829 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4830 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4831 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4832 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4833
4834 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4835
4836 Example :
4837 option splice-response
4838
4839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4841
4842 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4843 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4844
4845
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004846option srvtcpka
4847no option srvtcpka
4848 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4850 yes | no | yes | yes
4851 Arguments : none
4852
4853 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4854 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4855 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4856 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4857
4858 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4859 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4860 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4861 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4862
4863 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4864 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4865 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4866 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4867 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4868
4869 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4870
4871 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4872 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4873 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4874
4875 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4876 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4877
4878 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4879
4880
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004881option ssl-hello-chk
4882 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4884 yes | no | yes | yes
4885 Arguments : none
4886
4887 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4888 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4889 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4890 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4891 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4892 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4893 hello message.
4894
4895 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4896 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4897 messages, which is appreciable.
4898
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004899 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4900 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4901 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004902
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004903 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4904
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004905
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004906option tcp-check
4907 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4909 yes | no | yes | yes
4910
4911 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4912 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4913
4914 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4915 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4916 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4917
4918 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentionned : this is
4919 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4920 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4921 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4922 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4923 only.
4924
4925 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentionned : this is used to test a banner.
4926 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4927 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4928 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4929 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4930
4931 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentionned : this is
4932 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4933 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
4934 the maching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
4935 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4936 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4937 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4938 the respective protocols.
4939 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4940 analysed.
4941
4942 Examples :
4943 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4944 option tcp-check
4945 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4946
4947 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4948 option tcp-check
4949 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4950
4951 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4952 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
4953 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 tims)
4954 option tcp-check
4955 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4956 tcp-check expect +PONG
4957 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4958 tcp-check expect string role:master
4959 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4960 tcp-check expect string +OK
4961
4962 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4963 (send many headers before analyzing)
4964 option tcp-check
4965 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4966 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4967 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4968 tcp-check send \r\n
4969 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4970
4971
4972 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4973
4974
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004975option tcp-smart-accept
4976no option tcp-smart-accept
4977 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4979 yes | yes | yes | no
4980 Arguments : none
4981
4982 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4983 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4984 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4985 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4986 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4987 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4988
4989 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4990 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4991 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4992 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4993
4994 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4995 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4996 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4997 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4998
4999 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5000 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5001 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5002
5003 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5004 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5005 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5006
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005007 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5008
5009
5010option tcp-smart-connect
5011no option tcp-smart-connect
5012 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 yes | no | yes | yes
5015 Arguments : none
5016
5017 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5018 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5019 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5020 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5021 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5022
5023 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5024 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5025 complex.
5026
5027 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5028 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5029 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5030
5031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5033
5034 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5035
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005036
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005037option tcpka
5038 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5040 yes | yes | yes | yes
5041 Arguments : none
5042
5043 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5044 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5045 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5046 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5047
5048 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5049 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5050 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5051 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5052
5053 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5054 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5055 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5056 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5057 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5058
5059 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5060
5061 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5062 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5063 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5064 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5065 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5066 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5067 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5068 backends.
5069
5070 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5071
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005072
5073option tcplog
5074 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5076 yes | yes | yes | yes
5077 Arguments : none
5078
5079 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5080 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5081 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5082 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5083 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5084 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5085 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5086 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5087
5088 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005090 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005091
5092
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005093option transparent
5094no option transparent
5095 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005097 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005098 Arguments : none
5099
5100 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5101 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5102 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5103 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5104 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5105 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5106 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5107 appropriate server.
5108
5109 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5110 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5111
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005112 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005113 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005114
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005115
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005116persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005117persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005118 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5120 yes | no | yes | yes
5121 Arguments :
5122 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005123 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5124 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005125
5126 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5127 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5128 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5129 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5130 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5131 forwarded to this server.
5132
5133 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5134 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5135 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005136 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005137 a single "listen" section.
5138
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005139 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5140 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5141 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5142
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005143 Example :
5144 listen tse-farm
5145 bind :3389
5146 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5147 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5148 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5149 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5150 persist rdp-cookie
5151 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005152 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005153 balance rdp-cookie
5154 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5155 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5156
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005157 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5158 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005159
5160
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005161rate-limit sessions <rate>
5162 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | yes | yes | no
5165 Arguments :
5166 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5167 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5168
5169 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5170 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5171 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5172 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5173 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5174 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5175
5176 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5177 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5178 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5179 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5180
5181 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5182 listen smtp
5183 mode tcp
5184 bind :25
5185 rate-limit sessions 10
5186 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5187
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005188 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5189 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5190 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005191
5192 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5193
5194
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005195redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5196redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5197redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005198 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5200 no | yes | yes | yes
5201
5202 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005203 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005204
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005205 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005206 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005207 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5208 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5209 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005210
5211 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5212 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5213 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5214 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5215 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005216 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5217 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5218 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5219 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005220
5221 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5222 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5223 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5224 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5225 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5226 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
5227 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
5228 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005229 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5230 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5231 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005232
5233 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005234 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5235 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5236 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5237 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5238 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5239 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5240 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5241 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005242
5243 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5244 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5245
5246 - "drop-query"
5247 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5248 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5249 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5250 with a location-type redirect.
5251
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005252 - "append-slash"
5253 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5254 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5255 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5256 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5257
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005258 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5259 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5260 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5261 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5262 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5263 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5264 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5265
5266 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5267 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5268 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5269 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5270 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5271 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5272 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005273
5274 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5275 acl clear dst_port 80
5276 acl secure dst_port 8080
5277 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005278 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005279 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005280 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5281
5282 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005283 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5284 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5285 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005286 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005287
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005288 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5289 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5290 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5291
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005292 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005293 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005294
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005295 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5296 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5297 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005299 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005300
5301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005302redisp (deprecated)
5303redispatch (deprecated)
5304 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5306 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005307 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005308
5309 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5310 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5311 be able to access the service anymore.
5312
5313 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5314 redistribute them to a working server.
5315
5316 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5317 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5318 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005320 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5321 "option redispatch" instead.
5322
5323 See also : "option redispatch"
5324
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005325
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005326reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005327 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 no | yes | yes | yes
5330 Arguments :
5331 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5332 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005333 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005334
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005335 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5336 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5337
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005338 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5339 the last header of an HTTP request.
5340
5341 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5342 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5343 responses.
5344
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005345 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5346 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5347 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5348
5349 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5350 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005351
5352
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005353reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5354reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005355 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5357 no | yes | yes | yes
5358 Arguments :
5359 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5360 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5361 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5362 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5363 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5364 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5365 ignores case.
5366
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005367 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5368 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5369
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005370 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5371 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5372 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5373 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005374 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005375
5376 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5377 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5378
5379 Example :
5380 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5381 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5382 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5383
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005384 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5385 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005386
5387
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005388reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5389reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005390 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5392 no | yes | yes | yes
5393 Arguments :
5394 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5395 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5396 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5397 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5398 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5399 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5400
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005401 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5402 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5403
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005404 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5405 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5406 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5407 next servers.
5408
5409 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5410 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5411 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5412
5413 Example :
5414 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5415 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5416 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5417
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005418 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5419 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005420
5421
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005422reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5423reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005424 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5426 no | yes | yes | yes
5427 Arguments :
5428 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5429 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5430 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5431 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5432 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5433 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5434 case.
5435
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005436 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5437 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5438
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005439 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5440 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5441 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5442 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005443 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005444
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005445 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005446 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005447 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005448
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005449 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5450 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5451
5452 Example :
5453 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5454 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5455 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5456
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005457 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5458 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005459
5460
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005461reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5462reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005463 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 no | yes | yes | yes
5466 Arguments :
5467 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5468 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5469 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5470 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5471 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5472 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5473 case.
5474
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005475 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5476 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5477
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005478 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5479 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5480 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5481 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5482
5483 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5484 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5485
5486 Example :
5487 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5488 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5489 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5490 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5491
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005492 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5493 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005494
5495
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005496reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5497reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005498 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5500 no | yes | yes | yes
5501 Arguments :
5502 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5503 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5504 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5505 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5506 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5507 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5508
5509 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5510 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5511 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5512 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005513 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005514
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005515 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5516 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5517
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005518 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5519 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5520 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5521
5522 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5523 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5524 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5525 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5526 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5527
5528 Example :
5529 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005530 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005531 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5532 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5533
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005534 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5535 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005536
5537
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005538reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5539reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005540 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5542 no | yes | yes | yes
5543 Arguments :
5544 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5545 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5546 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5547 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5548 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5549 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5550 ignores case.
5551
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005552 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5553 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5554
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005555 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5556 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005557 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5558 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5559 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005560 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5561 not set.
5562
5563 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5564 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5565 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5566 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5567 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5568
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005569 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005570 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5571 # block all others.
5572 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5573 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5574
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005575 # block bad guys
5576 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5577 reqitarpit . if badguys
5578
5579 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5580 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005581
5582
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005583retries <value>
5584 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | no | yes | yes
5587 Arguments :
5588 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5589 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5590 default value is 3.
5591
5592 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5593 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5594 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5595
5596 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5597 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5598
5599 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5600 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5601
5602 See also : "option redispatch"
5603
5604
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005605rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005606 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5608 no | yes | yes | yes
5609 Arguments :
5610 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5611 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005612 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005613
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005614 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5615 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5616
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005617 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5618 the last header of an HTTP response.
5619
5620 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5621 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5622 responses.
5623
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005624 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5625 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005626
5627
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005628rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5629rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005630 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5632 no | yes | yes | yes
5633 Arguments :
5634 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5635 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5636 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5637 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5638 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5639 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5640 ignores case.
5641
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005642 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5643 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5644
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005645 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5646 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005647 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005648 client.
5649
5650 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5651 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5652 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5653
5654 Example :
5655 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005656 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005657
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005658 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5659 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005660
5661
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005662rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5663rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005664 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5666 no | yes | yes | yes
5667 Arguments :
5668 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5669 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5670 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5671 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5672 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5673 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5674 ignores case.
5675
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005676 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5677 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5678
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005679 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5680 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5681 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5682 case-sensitive.
5683
5684 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005685 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5686 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5687 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005688
5689 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5690 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5691
5692 Example :
5693 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5694 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5695
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005696 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5697 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005698
5699
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005700rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5701rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005702 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5704 no | yes | yes | yes
5705 Arguments :
5706 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5707 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5708 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5709 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5710 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5711 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5712 ignores case.
5713
5714 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5715 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5716 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5717 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005718 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005719
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005720 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5721 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5722
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005723 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5724 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5725 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5726
5727 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5728 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5729 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5730 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5731 are not case-sensitive.
5732
5733 Example :
5734 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5735 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5736
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005737 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5738 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005739
5740
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005741server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005742 Declare a server in a backend
5743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5744 no | no | yes | yes
5745 Arguments :
5746 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005747 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005748 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005749
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005750 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5751 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5752 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5753 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005754 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5755 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5756 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5757 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5758 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005759 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5760 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5761 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5762 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5763 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5764 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5765 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005766 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5767 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5768 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5769 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005770
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005771 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005772 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5773 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5774 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5775 adding this value to the client's port.
5776
5777 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5778 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005779 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005780
5781 Examples :
5782 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5783 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005784 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005785 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5786 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5787 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005788
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005789 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5790 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005791
5792
5793source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005794source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005795source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005796 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5798 yes | no | yes | yes
5799 Arguments :
5800 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5801 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005802
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005803 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005804 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5805 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5806 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5807 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5808 supported prefixes are :
5809 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5810 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5811 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005812 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5813 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5814 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5815 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005816
5817 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5818 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005819 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5820 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5821 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005822
5823 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5824 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5825 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5826 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5827 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5828 <addr>.
5829
5830 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5831 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5832 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5833 port.
5834
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005835 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5836 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5837 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5838 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005839 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005840 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5841 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5842 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5843 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5844 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5845 HTTP header.
5846
5847 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5848 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005849 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005850 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5851 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5852 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5853 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5854 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5855 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5856 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5857
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005858 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5859 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5860 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5861 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5862 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5863 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5864
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005865 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5866 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5867 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5868 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5869
5870 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5871 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5872 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5873 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5874 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5875 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5876
5877 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5878 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5879 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5880 there are two methods :
5881
5882 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5883 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5884 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5885 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5886 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5887 of the client ranges may be used.
5888
5889 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5890 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5891 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5892 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5893 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5894 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5895 same session.
5896
5897 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5898 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5899 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5900 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5901 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5902 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5903
5904 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5905 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5906 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005907 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005908
5909 Examples :
5910 backend private
5911 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5912 source 192.168.1.200
5913
5914 backend transparent_ssl1
5915 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5916 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5917
5918 backend transparent_ssl2
5919 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5920 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5921 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5922
5923 backend transparent_ssl3
5924 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5925 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5926 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5927
5928 backend transparent_smtp
5929 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5930 # with Tproxy version 4.
5931 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5932
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005933 backend transparent_http
5934 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5935 # proxy.
5936 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005938 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005939 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005941
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005942srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5943 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5945 yes | no | yes | yes
5946 Arguments :
5947 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5948 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5949 as explained at the top of this document.
5950
5951 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5952 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5953 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5954 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5955 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5956 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5957 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5958
5959 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5960 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5961 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5962 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5963 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005964 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005965 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005966 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005967
5968 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5969 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5970 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5971 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5972 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5973 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5974
5975 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5976 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5977
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005978 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5979 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005980
5981
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005982stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5983 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5985 no | no | yes | yes
5986
5987 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5988 matched.
5989
5990 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5991 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5992
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005993 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5994 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5995 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5996
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005997 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5998 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5999 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6000 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006001
6002 Example :
6003 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6004 backend stats_localhost
6005 stats enable
6006 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6007
6008 Example :
6009 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6010 backend stats_auth
6011 stats enable
6012 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6013 stats admin if TRUE
6014
6015 Example :
6016 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6017 userlist stats-auth
6018 group admin users admin
6019 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6020 group readonly users haproxy
6021 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6022
6023 backend stats_auth
6024 stats enable
6025 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6026 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6027 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6028 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6029
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006030 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6031 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6032 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006033
6034
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006035stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6036 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6038 yes | no | yes | yes
6039 Arguments :
6040 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6041
6042 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6043
6044 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6045 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6046 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6047 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6048 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6049 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6050
6051 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6052 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6053 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006054 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006055
6056 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6057 report using "stats scope".
6058
6059 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6060 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6061 unobvious parameters.
6062
6063 Example :
6064 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6065 backend public_www
6066 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6067 stats enable
6068 stats hide-version
6069 stats scope .
6070 stats uri /admin?stats
6071 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6072 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6073 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6074
6075 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6076 backend private_monitoring
6077 stats enable
6078 stats uri /admin?stats
6079 stats refresh 5s
6080
6081 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6082
6083
6084stats enable
6085 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6087 yes | no | yes | yes
6088 Arguments : none
6089
6090 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6091 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6092 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6093 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6094 - stats auth : no authentication
6095 - stats scope : no restriction
6096
6097 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6098 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6099 unobvious parameters.
6100
6101 Example :
6102 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6103 backend public_www
6104 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6105 stats enable
6106 stats hide-version
6107 stats scope .
6108 stats uri /admin?stats
6109 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6110 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6111 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6112
6113 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6114 backend private_monitoring
6115 stats enable
6116 stats uri /admin?stats
6117 stats refresh 5s
6118
6119 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6120
6121
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006122stats hide-version
6123 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006126 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006127
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006128 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6129 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6130 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6131 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6132 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6133 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006135 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6136 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6137 unobvious parameters.
6138
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006139 Example :
6140 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6141 backend public_www
6142 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006143 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006144 stats hide-version
6145 stats scope .
6146 stats uri /admin?stats
6147 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6148 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6149 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006150
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006151 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6152 backend private_monitoring
6153 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006154 stats uri /admin?stats
6155 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006156
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006157 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006158
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006159
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006160stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6161 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6162 Access control for statistics
6163
6164 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6165 no | no | yes | yes
6166
6167 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6168 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6169 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6170 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6171 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6172 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6173
6174 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6175 instance.
6176
6177 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6178 about ACL usage.
6179
6180
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006181stats realm <realm>
6182 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6184 yes | no | yes | yes
6185 Arguments :
6186 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6187 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6188 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6189
6190 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6191 using a backslash ('\').
6192
6193 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6194 only related to authentication.
6195
6196 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6197 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6198 unobvious parameters.
6199
6200 Example :
6201 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6202 backend public_www
6203 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6204 stats enable
6205 stats hide-version
6206 stats scope .
6207 stats uri /admin?stats
6208 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6209 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6210 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6211
6212 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6213 backend private_monitoring
6214 stats enable
6215 stats uri /admin?stats
6216 stats refresh 5s
6217
6218 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6219
6220
6221stats refresh <delay>
6222 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6224 yes | no | yes | yes
6225 Arguments :
6226 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6227 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6228 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6229 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6230 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6231 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6232
6233 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6234 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6235 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6236 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6237
6238 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6239 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6240 unobvious parameters.
6241
6242 Example :
6243 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6244 backend public_www
6245 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6246 stats enable
6247 stats hide-version
6248 stats scope .
6249 stats uri /admin?stats
6250 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6251 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6252 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6253
6254 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6255 backend private_monitoring
6256 stats enable
6257 stats uri /admin?stats
6258 stats refresh 5s
6259
6260 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6261
6262
6263stats scope { <name> | "." }
6264 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | no | yes | yes
6267 Arguments :
6268 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6269 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6270 section in which the statement appears.
6271
6272 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6273 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6274 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6275 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6276 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6277 exists.
6278
6279 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6280 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6281 unobvious parameters.
6282
6283 Example :
6284 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6285 backend public_www
6286 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6287 stats enable
6288 stats hide-version
6289 stats scope .
6290 stats uri /admin?stats
6291 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6292 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6293 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6294
6295 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6296 backend private_monitoring
6297 stats enable
6298 stats uri /admin?stats
6299 stats refresh 5s
6300
6301 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6302
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006303
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006304stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006305 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6307 yes | no | yes | yes
6308
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006309 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006310 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6311
6312 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6313 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6314
6315 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6316 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006317 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006318
6319 Example :
6320 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6321 backend private_monitoring
6322 stats enable
6323 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6324 stats uri /admin?stats
6325 stats refresh 5s
6326
6327 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6328 global section.
6329
6330
6331stats show-legends
6332 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
6333 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6334 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6335 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6336 - IP (socket, server)
6337 - cookie (backend, server)
6338
6339 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6340 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006341 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006342
6343 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6344
6345
6346stats show-node [ <name> ]
6347 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6349 yes | no | yes | yes
6350 Arguments:
6351 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6352 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6353
6354 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6355 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006356 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006357
6358 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6359 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6360 unobvious parameters.
6361
6362 Example:
6363 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6364 backend private_monitoring
6365 stats enable
6366 stats show-node Europe-1
6367 stats uri /admin?stats
6368 stats refresh 5s
6369
6370 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6371 section.
6372
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006373
6374stats uri <prefix>
6375 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6377 yes | no | yes | yes
6378 Arguments :
6379 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6380 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6381 query string.
6382
6383 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6384 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6385 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6386 possible to reach it in the application.
6387
6388 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006389 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006390 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6391 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6392 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6393 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6394
6395 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6396 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6397 an address or a port to statistics only.
6398
6399 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6400 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6401 unobvious parameters.
6402
6403 Example :
6404 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6405 backend public_www
6406 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6407 stats enable
6408 stats hide-version
6409 stats scope .
6410 stats uri /admin?stats
6411 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6412 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6413 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6414
6415 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6416 backend private_monitoring
6417 stats enable
6418 stats uri /admin?stats
6419 stats refresh 5s
6420
6421 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6422
6423
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006424stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6425 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006427 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006428
6429 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006430 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006431 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6432 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6433 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6434
6435 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6436 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6437 the "stick-table" statement.
6438
6439 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6440 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6441 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6442 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6443 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6444
6445 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6446 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6447 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6448 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6449 transformation rules.
6450
6451 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6452 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6453 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6454 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6455 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6456 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6457 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6458
6459 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6460 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6461 ACL based conditions.
6462
6463 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6464 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6465 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6466 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6467
6468 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6469 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6470 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6471 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6472
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006473 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6474 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6475 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6476
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006477 Example :
6478 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6479 # last 30 minutes
6480 backend pop
6481 mode tcp
6482 balance roundrobin
6483 stick store-request src
6484 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6485 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6486 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6487
6488 backend smtp
6489 mode tcp
6490 balance roundrobin
6491 stick match src table pop
6492 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6493 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6494
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006495 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6496 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006497
6498
6499stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6500 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 no | no | yes | yes
6503
6504 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6505 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6506 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6507 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6508
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006509 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6510 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6511 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6512
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006513 Examples :
6514 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006515 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006516
6517 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6518 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6519 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6520
6521
6522 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6523 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6524 backend http
6525 mode http
6526 balance roundrobin
6527 stick on src table https
6528 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6529 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6530 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6531
6532 backend https
6533 mode tcp
6534 balance roundrobin
6535 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6536 stick on src
6537 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6538 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6539
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006540 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006541
6542
6543stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6544 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6546 no | no | yes | yes
6547
6548 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006549 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006550 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6551 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6552 server is selected.
6553
6554 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6555 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6556 the "stick-table" statement.
6557
6558 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6559 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6560 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6561 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6562 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6563 address.
6564
6565 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6566 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6567 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6568 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6569 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6570 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6571 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6572 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6573 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6574 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6575
6576 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6577 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6578 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6579 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6580 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6581 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6582 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6583
6584 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6585 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6586 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6587 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6588
6589 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6590 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6591 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6592 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6593 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6594 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006595 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6596 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6597 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6598 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6599 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6600 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006601
6602 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6603 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6604 the request.
6605
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006606 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6607 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6608 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6609
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006610 Example :
6611 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6612 # last 30 minutes
6613 backend pop
6614 mode tcp
6615 balance roundrobin
6616 stick store-request src
6617 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6618 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6619 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6620
6621 backend smtp
6622 mode tcp
6623 balance roundrobin
6624 stick match src table pop
6625 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6626 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6627
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006628 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6629 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006630
6631
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006632stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006633 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6634 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006635 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006637 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006638
6639 Arguments :
6640 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6641 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6642 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6643 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6644
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006645 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6646 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6647 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6648 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6649
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006650 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6651 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6652 instance.
6653
6654 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6655 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6656 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6657 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6658 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6659 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006660 to 32 characters.
6661
6662 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6663 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6664 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6665 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6666 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6667 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006668
6669 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006670 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6671 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006672 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6673 increase.
6674
6675 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006676 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6677 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6678 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006679
6680 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6681 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6682 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6683 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6684 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6685 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6686 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6687 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6688 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6689 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6690 parameter (see below).
6691
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006692 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6693 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6694 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6695 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6696 soft restart.
6697
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006698 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6699
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006700 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6701 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6702 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6703 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6704 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006705 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006706 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6707 if not expiration delay is specified.
6708
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006709 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6710 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6711 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6712 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006713 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6714 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6715 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6716 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6717 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6718 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6719 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6720 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6721 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6722 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6723 types and their arguments.
6724
6725 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6726 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6727 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6728 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6729
6730 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6731 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6732 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6733 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6734
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006735 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6736 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6737 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6738 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6739 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6740 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6741
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006742 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6743 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6744 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6745 they were received.
6746
6747 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6748 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6749 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6750 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6751 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6752
6753 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6754 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6755 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6756 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6757 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6758
6759 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6760 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6761 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6762
6763 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6764 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6765 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6766 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6767 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6768
6769 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6770 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6771 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6772 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6773 the client side.
6774
6775 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6776 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6777 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6778 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6779 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6780 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6781 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6782
6783 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6784 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6785 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6786 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6787 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6788 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6789 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6790
6791 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6792 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6793 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6794 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6795 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6796 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6797
6798 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6799 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6800 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6801 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6802
6803 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6804 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6805 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6806 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6807 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6808 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6809 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6810 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6811 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6812 recommended for better fairness.
6813
6814 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6815 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6816 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6817 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6818
6819 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6820 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6821 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6822 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6823 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6824 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6825 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6826 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6827 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6828 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006829
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006830 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6831 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006832 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6833 reference it.
6834
6835 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6836 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6837 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6838 as an exclusive stickiness.
6839
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006840 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6841 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6842 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6843 something that can be ignored.
6844
6845 Example:
6846 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6847 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6848 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6849 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6850
6851 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006852 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006853
6854
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006855stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6856 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6858 no | no | yes | yes
6859
6860 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006861 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006862 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6863 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6864 server is selected.
6865
6866 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6867 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6868 the "stick-table" statement.
6869
6870 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6871 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6872 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6873 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6874
6875 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6876 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6877 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6878 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6879 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6880 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006881 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006882 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6883 rules.
6884
6885 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6886 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6887 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6888 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6889 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6890 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6891 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6892
6893 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6894 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6895 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6896 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6897
6898 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6899 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6900 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6901 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6902 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6903 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006904 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6905 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6906 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6907 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6908 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6909 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6910 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6911 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6912 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006913
6914 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6915
6916 Example :
6917 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6918 backend https
6919 mode tcp
6920 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006921 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006922 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006923
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006924 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6925 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6926
6927 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6928 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6929 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6930
6931 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6932 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006933
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006934 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6935 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6936 # at offset 44.
6937
6938 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6939 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6940
6941 # Learn on response if server hello.
6942 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006943
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006944 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6945 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6946
6947 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6948 extraction.
6949
6950
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006951tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6952 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6954 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006955 Arguments :
6956 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006957 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6958 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006960 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006961
6962 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6963 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006964 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6965 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6966 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6967 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6968 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6969 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006970
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006971 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6972 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6973 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6974 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006975
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006976 Three types of actions are supported :
6977 - accept :
6978 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6979 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6980 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006982 - reject :
6983 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6984 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6985 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6986 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6987 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6988 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6989 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6990 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6991 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6992 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6993 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6994 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006995
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006996 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6997 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6998 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6999 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7000 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7001 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7002 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7003 hosts.
7004
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007005 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007006 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7007 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7008 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007009 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7010 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007011 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007012 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7013 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7014 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7015 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7016 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007018 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007019 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007020 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007021 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7022 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7023 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7024 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007025
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007026 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7027 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7028 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7029 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007030
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007031 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7032 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7033 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7034 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7035 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007036 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7037 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7038 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7039 layer7 information is extracted.
7040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007041 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7042 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7043 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7044 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7045 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007047 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7048 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7049 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007050
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007051 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7052 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7053 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007055 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007056 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007057 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007059 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7060 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7061 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007063 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007064 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7065 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007066
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007067 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7068
7069 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7070
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007071 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007073 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007074
7075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007076tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7077 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007079 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007080 Arguments :
7081 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007082 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7083 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007084 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007086 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007088 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7089 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7090 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7091 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7092 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007093
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007094 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7095 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7096 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7097 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007098 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7099 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7100 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7101 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7102 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7103 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
7104 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditionned by an
7105 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007107 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7108 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7109 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7110 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007112 Three types of actions are supported :
7113 - accept :
7114 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007115 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007117 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7118 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007119
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007120 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7121 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7122 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7123 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7124 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7125 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007127 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007128 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7129 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007130
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007131 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007132 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7133 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7134 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7135 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007136 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7137 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7138 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007139
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007140 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7141 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7142 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7143 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7144
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007145 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007146 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7147 # and reject everything else.
7148 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7149 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007150 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007151 tcp-request content reject
7152
7153 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007154 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7155 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7156 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007157 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007158
7159 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7160 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7161 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007162 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007163 tcp-request content reject
7164
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007165 Example:
7166 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7167 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007168 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007169
7170 Example:
7171 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7172 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007173 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007174
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007175 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7176 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7177
7178 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007179 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007180 # protecting all our sites
7181 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007182 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7183 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007184 ...
7185 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7186
7187 backend http_dynamic
7188 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007189 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007190 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007191 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7192 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7193 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007194 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007196 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007197
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007198 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007199
7200
7201tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7202 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007204 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007205 Arguments :
7206 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7207 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7208 as explained at the top of this document.
7209
7210 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7211 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7212 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7213 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7214 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7215
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007216 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7217 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7218 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7219 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7220
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007221 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7222 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007223 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007224 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007225 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7226 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7227 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7228 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007229
7230 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7231 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7232 it pass through unaffected.
7233
7234 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7235 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7236 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007237 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007238 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7239 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007240 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7241 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7242 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007243
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007244 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007245 "timeout client".
7246
7247
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007248tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7249 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7251 no | no | yes | yes
7252 Arguments :
7253 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007254 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007255
7256 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7257
7258 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7259 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7260 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007261 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7262 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007263
7264 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7265
7266 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7267 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7268 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7269 inserted.
7270
7271 Two types of actions are supported :
7272 - accept :
7273 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7274 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7275 the rules evaluation.
7276
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007277 - close :
7278 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7279 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7280 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7281 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7282 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7283 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
7284 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
7285 protocols.
7286
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007287 - reject :
7288 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7289 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007290 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007291
7292 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7293 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7294 for changing the default action to a reject.
7295
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007296 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7297 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7298 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7299 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007300 period.
7301
7302 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7303
7304 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7305
7306
7307tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7308 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7310 no | no | yes | yes
7311 Arguments :
7312 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7313 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7314 as explained at the top of this document.
7315
7316 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7317
7318
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007319timeout check <timeout>
7320 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7321 established.
7322
7323 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7324 yes | no | yes | yes
7325 Arguments:
7326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7328 as explained at the top of this document.
7329
7330 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7331 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7332 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7333 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007334 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7335 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7336 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007337
7338 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7339 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7340
7341 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7342 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007343 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007344
7345 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7346 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7347 forget about it.
7348
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007349 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7350 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007351
7352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007353timeout client <timeout>
7354timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7355 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7357 yes | yes | yes | no
7358 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007359 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007360 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7361 as explained at the top of this document.
7362
7363 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7364 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7365 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7366 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7367 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7368 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7369 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7370 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007371 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007372 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007373 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7374 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7375 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007376
7377 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7378 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7379 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7380 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7381 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7382 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7383
7384 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7385 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7386 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7387
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007388 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007389
7390
7391timeout connect <timeout>
7392timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7393 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7395 yes | no | yes | yes
7396 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007397 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007398 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7399 as explained at the top of this document.
7400
7401 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007402 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007403 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007404 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007405 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7406 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007407
7408 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7409 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7410 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7411 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7412 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7413 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7414
7415 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7416 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7417 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7418
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007419 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7420 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007421
7422
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007423timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7424 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7426 yes | yes | yes | yes
7427 Arguments :
7428 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7430 as explained at the top of this document.
7431
7432 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7433 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7434 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7435 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7436 once the request has started to present itself.
7437
7438 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7439 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7440 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7441 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7442 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7443
7444 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7445 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7446 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7447 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7448
7449 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7450 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7451 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7452 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7453 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007454 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007455
7456 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7457 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7458 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7459 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7460
7461 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7462
7463
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007464timeout http-request <timeout>
7465 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007467 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007468 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007469 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007470 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7471 as explained at the top of this document.
7472
7473 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7474 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7475 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7476 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7477 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7478 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7479 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7480 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7481
7482 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7483 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007484 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7485 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007486
7487 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7488 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7489 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7490 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7491 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7492
7493 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007494 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7495 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7496 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007497
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007498 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007499
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007500
7501timeout queue <timeout>
7502 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7504 yes | no | yes | yes
7505 Arguments :
7506 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7507 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7508 as explained at the top of this document.
7509
7510 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7511 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7512 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7513 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7514 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7515
7516 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7517 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7518 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7519 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7520
7521 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7522
7523
7524timeout server <timeout>
7525timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7526 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7528 yes | no | yes | yes
7529 Arguments :
7530 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7531 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7532 as explained at the top of this document.
7533
7534 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7535 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7536 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7537 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7538 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7539 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7540 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7541
7542 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7543 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7544 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7545 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7546 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007547 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007548 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007549 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7550 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7551 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7552 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007553
7554 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7555 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7556 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7557 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7558 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7559 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7560
7561 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7562 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7563 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7564
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007565 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007566
7567
7568timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007569 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7571 yes | yes | yes | yes
7572 Arguments :
7573 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7574 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7575 as explained at the top of this document.
7576
7577 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7578 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7579 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7580
7581 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7582 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7583 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7584 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007585 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007586
7587 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7588
7589
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007590timeout tunnel <timeout>
7591 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7593 yes | no | yes | yes
7594 Arguments :
7595 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7596 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7597 as explained at the top of this document.
7598
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007599 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007600 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7601 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7602 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7603 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7604 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7605 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7606 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7607 specified.
7608
7609 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7610 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7611 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7612 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7613 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7614
7615 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7616 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7617 forget about it.
7618
7619 Example :
7620 defaults http
7621 option http-server-close
7622 timeout connect 5s
7623 timeout client 30s
7624 timeout client 30s
7625 timeout server 30s
7626 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7627
7628 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7629
7630
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007631transparent (deprecated)
7632 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007634 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007635 Arguments : none
7636
7637 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7638 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7639 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7640 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7641 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7642 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7643 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7644 appropriate server.
7645
7646 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7647
7648 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7649 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7650
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007651 See also: "option transparent"
7652
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007653unique-id-format <string>
7654 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7656 yes | yes | yes | no
7657 Arguments :
7658 <string> is a log-format string.
7659
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007660 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7661 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7662 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7663 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007664
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007665 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7666 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7667 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7668 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7669 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7670 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7671 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7672 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007673
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007674 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7675 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007676
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007677 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007678
7679 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7680
7681 will generate:
7682
7683 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7684
7685 See also: "unique-id-header"
7686
7687unique-id-header <name>
7688 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7690 yes | yes | yes | no
7691 Arguments :
7692 <name> is the name of the header.
7693
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007694 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7695 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007696
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007697 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007698
7699 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7700 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7701
7702 will generate:
7703
7704 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7705
7706 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007707
7708use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7709use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007710 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7712 no | yes | yes | no
7713 Arguments :
7714 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007716 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007717
7718 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7719 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7720 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007721 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7722 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7723 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7724 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007725
7726 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7727 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7728 assign the backend.
7729
7730 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7731 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7732 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7733 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7734 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7735 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7736
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007737 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007738 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007739 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7740 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7741 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7742
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007743 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007744
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007745
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007746use-server <server> if <condition>
7747use-server <server> unless <condition>
7748 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7750 no | no | yes | yes
7751 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007752 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007753
7754 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7755
7756 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7757 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7758 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7759
7760 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7761 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7762 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7763 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7764 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7765 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7766 matches will assign the server.
7767
7768 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7769 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7770 with the next rules until one matches.
7771
7772 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7773 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7774 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7775 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7776
7777 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7778 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7779 stripped.
7780
7781 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7782 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7783 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7784 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7785
7786 Example :
7787 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7788 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7789 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7790 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7791 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7792 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7793 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7794 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7795 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7796
7797 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007799
78005. Bind and Server options
7801--------------------------
7802
7803The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7804depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7805settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7806written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7807described in this section.
7808
7809
78105.1. Bind options
7811-----------------
7812
7813The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7814as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7815no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7816parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7817while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7818provided immediately after the setting name.
7819
7820The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7821
7822accept-proxy
7823 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7824 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7825 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7826 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7827 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7828 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7829 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7830 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7831 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007832 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7833 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007834
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007835alpn <protocols>
7836 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7837 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7838 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7839 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7840 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7841 initial NPN extension.
7842
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007843backlog <backlog>
7844 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7845 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7846
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007847ecdhe <named curve>
7848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007849 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7850 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007851
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007852ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7854 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7855 client's certificate.
7856
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007857ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7859 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7860 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7861 error is ignored.
7862
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007863ciphers <ciphers>
7864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7865 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7866 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7867 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7868 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7869
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007870crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7872 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7873 to verify client's certificate.
7874
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007875crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7877 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7878 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7879 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7880 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7881 file.
7882
7883 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7884 are loaded.
7885
7886 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7887 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7888 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7889 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7890 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7891 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7892 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7893 www.sub.example.org).
7894
7895 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7896 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7897 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7898 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7899 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7900
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007901 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007902
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007903 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7904 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7905 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7906 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7907 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7908 clients).
7909
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007910crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7912 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7913 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7914 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007915
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007916crt-list <file>
7917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007918 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7919 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007920
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007921 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007922
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007923 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7924 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7925 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7926 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7927 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7928 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7929 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7930 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007931
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007932defer-accept
7933 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7934 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7935 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7936 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7937 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7938 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7939 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7940 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7941 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7942 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7943 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7944
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007945force-sslv3
7946 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7947 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7948 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7949
7950force-tlsv10
7951 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7952 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7953
7954force-tlsv11
7955 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7956 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7957
7958force-tlsv12
7959 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7960 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7961
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007962gid <gid>
7963 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7964 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7965 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7966 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7967 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7968
7969group <group>
7970 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7971 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7972 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7973 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7974 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7975
7976id <id>
7977 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7978 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7979 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7980 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7981
7982interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007983 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7984 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7985 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7986 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7987 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7988 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7989 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007990
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007991level <level>
7992 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7993 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7994 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7995 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7996 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7997 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7998 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7999 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8000 counters).
8001 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8002 all counters).
8003
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008004maxconn <maxconn>
8005 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8006 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8007 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8008 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8009 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8010 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8011 eat all memory.
8012
8013mode <mode>
8014 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8015 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8016 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8017 UNIX sockets.
8018
8019mss <maxseg>
8020 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8021 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8022 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8023 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8024 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8025 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8026 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8027 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8028 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8029 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8030 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8031
8032name <name>
8033 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8034 page.
8035
8036nice <nice>
8037 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8038 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8039 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8040 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8041 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8042 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8043 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8044 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8045 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8046 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8047 one for an RDP socket.
8048
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008049no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8051 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
8052 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008053 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8054 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008055
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008056no-tls-tickets
8057 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8058 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8059 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8060 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8061
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008062no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008064 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
8065 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8066 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8067 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008068
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008069no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008071 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
8072 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8073 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8074 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008075
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008076no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008078 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
8079 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8080 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8081 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008082
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008083npn <protocols>
8084 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8085 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8086 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8087 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008088 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8089 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008090
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008091ssl
8092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8093 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
8094 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8095 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8096 to deciphered contents.
8097
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008098strict-sni
8099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8100 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8101 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8102 See the "crt" option for more information.
8103
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008104tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008105 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008106 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8107 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8108 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8109 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8110 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8111 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8112 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008113 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8114 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8115 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008116
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008117transparent
8118 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8119 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8120 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8121 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8122 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8123 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8124 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8125 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8126 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8127 so check for support with your vendor.
8128
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008129v4v6
8130 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8131 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8132 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8133 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
8134 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
8135
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008136v6only
8137 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8138 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8139 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008140 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8141 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008142
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008143uid <uid>
8144 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8145 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8146 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8147 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8148 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8149
8150user <user>
8151 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8152 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8153 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8154 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8155 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8156
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008157verify [none|optional|required]
8158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8159 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8160 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8161 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8162 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008163 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8164 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8165 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8166 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008167
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020081685.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008169------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008170
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008171The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8172which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8173arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8174settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8175after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8176Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8177address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008179 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008180 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008182The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008183
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008184addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008185 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8186 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8187 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8188 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8189 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008190
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008191 Supported in default-server: No
8192
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008193agent-check
8194 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8195 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8196 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8197 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8198
8199 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8200 e.g. "75%"
8201
8202 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8203 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8204
8205 * The string "drain".
8206
8207 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8208 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8209 persistence.
8210
8211 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8212
8213 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8214
8215 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8216
8217 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8218
8219 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8220
8221 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8222
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008223 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8224 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8225 parameter.
8226
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008227 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8228 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8229
8230 Supported in default-server: No
8231
8232agent-inter <delay>
8233 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8234 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8235
8236 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8237 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8238 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8239 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8240 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8241 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8242 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8243 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8244 of backends use the same servers.
8245
8246 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8247
8248 Supported in default-server: Yes
8249
8250agent-port <port>
8251 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8252
8253 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8254
8255 Supported in default-server: Yes
8256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008257backup
8258 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8259 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8260 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8261 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8262 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8263 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008265 Supported in default-server: No
8266
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008267ca-file <cafile>
8268 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8269 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8270 server's certificate.
8271
8272 Supported in default-server: No
8273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008274check
8275 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008276 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8277 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8278 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8279 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8280 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8281 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8282 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008283 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8284 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8285 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008287 Supported in default-server: No
8288
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008289check-send-proxy
8290 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8291 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8292 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8293 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8294 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8295 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8296 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8297
8298 Supported in default-server: No
8299
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008300check-ssl
8301 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8302 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8303 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8304 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
8305 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
8306 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8307 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8308 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8309 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8310
8311 Supported in default-server: No
8312
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008313ciphers <ciphers>
8314 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
8315 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
8316 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8317 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8318 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8319 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8320 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8321 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8322
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008323 Supported in default-server: No
8324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008325cookie <value>
8326 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8327 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8328 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8329 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8330 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8331 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8332 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008334 Supported in default-server: No
8335
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008336crl-file <crlfile>
8337 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8338 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8339 to verify server's certificate.
8340
8341 Supported in default-server: No
8342
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008343crt <cert>
8344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8345 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8346 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8347 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8348 certificate request.
8349
8350 Supported in default-server: No
8351
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008352disabled
8353 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8354 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8355 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8356 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8357 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8358
8359 Supported in default-server: No
8360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008361error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008362 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8363 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8364 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008366 Supported in default-server: Yes
8367
8368 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008370fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008371 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8372 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8373 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008375 Supported in default-server: Yes
8376
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008377force-sslv3
8378 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8379 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8380 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8381
8382 Supported in default-server: No
8383
8384force-tlsv10
8385 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8386 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8387
8388 Supported in default-server: No
8389
8390force-tlsv11
8391 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8392 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8393
8394 Supported in default-server: No
8395
8396force-tlsv12
8397 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8398 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8399
8400 Supported in default-server: No
8401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008402id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008403 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8404 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8405 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008407 Supported in default-server: No
8408
8409inter <delay>
8410fastinter <delay>
8411downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008412 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8413 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8414 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8415 between checks depending on the server state :
8416
8417 Server state | Interval used
8418 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8419 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8420 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8421 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8422 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8423 or yet unchecked. |
8424 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8425 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8426 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008428 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8429 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8430 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8431 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008432 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8433 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8434 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8435 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8436 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008438 Supported in default-server: Yes
8439
8440maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008441 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8442 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8443 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8444 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8445 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8446 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8447 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8448 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008450 Supported in default-server: Yes
8451
8452maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008453 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8454 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8455 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8456 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8457 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8458 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8459 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008461 Supported in default-server: Yes
8462
8463minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008464 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8465 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8466 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8467 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8468 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8469 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008470 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008471 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008473 Supported in default-server: Yes
8474
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008475no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008476 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8477 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008478 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008479
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008480 Supported in default-server: No
8481
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008482no-tls-tickets
8483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8484 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8485 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8486 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8487
8488 Supported in default-server: No
8489
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008490no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008491 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008492 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8493 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008494 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8495 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008496
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008497 Supported in default-server: No
8498
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008499no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008500 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008501 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8502 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008503 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8504 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008505
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008506 Supported in default-server: No
8507
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008508no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008509 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008510 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8511 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008512 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8513 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008514
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008515 Supported in default-server: No
8516
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008517non-stick
8518 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8519 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8520 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8521
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008522 Supported in default-server: No
8523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008524observe <mode>
8525 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8526 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8527 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8528 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8529 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8530 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008531 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008533 Supported in default-server: No
8534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008535 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008537on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008538 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8539 Currently, four modes are available:
8540 - fastinter: force fastinter
8541 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8542 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8543 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8544 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008546 Supported in default-server: Yes
8547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008548 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8549
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008550on-marked-down <action>
8551 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8552 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008553 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8554 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8555 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8556 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8557 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8558 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8559 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8560 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008561
8562 Actions are disabled by default
8563
8564 Supported in default-server: Yes
8565
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008566on-marked-up <action>
8567 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8568 Currently one action is available:
8569 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8570 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8571 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8572 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8573 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8574 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8575 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8576 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8577
8578 Actions are disabled by default
8579
8580 Supported in default-server: Yes
8581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008582port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008583 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8584 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8585 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8586 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8587 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8588 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008590 Supported in default-server: Yes
8591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008592redir <prefix>
8593 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8594 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8595 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8596 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8597 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8598 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8599 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8600 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008601 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008602 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8603 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8604 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8605 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8606 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8607
8608 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008610 Supported in default-server: No
8611
8612rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008613 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8614 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8615 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008617 Supported in default-server: Yes
8618
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008619send-proxy
8620 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8621 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8622 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8623 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8624 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8625 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8626 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8627 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8628 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008629 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8630 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8631 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8632 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8633 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008634
8635 Supported in default-server: No
8636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008637slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008638 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8639 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8640 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8641 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8642 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8643 parameters :
8644
8645 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8646 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8647
8648 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8649 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8650 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8651 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8652
8653 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8654 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8655 seen as failed.
8656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008657 Supported in default-server: Yes
8658
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008659source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008660source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008661source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008662 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8663 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8664 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8665 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8666
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008667 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8668 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8669 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8670 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8671 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8672 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8673 server.
8674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008675 Supported in default-server: No
8676
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008677ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008678 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8679 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8680 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8681 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8682 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8683 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8684 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008685
8686 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008688track [<proxy>/]<server>
8689 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8690 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8691 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8692 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8693 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008695 Supported in default-server: No
8696
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008697verify [none|required]
8698 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008699 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8700 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8701 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8702 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008703 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8704 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8705 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008706
8707 Supported in default-server: No
8708
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008709verifyhost <hostname>
8710 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8711 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8712 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8713 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8714 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8715 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8716
8717 Supported in default-server: No
8718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008719weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008720 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8721 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8722 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008723 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8724 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8725 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8726 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8727 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8728 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008730 Supported in default-server: Yes
8731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008732
87336. HTTP header manipulation
8734---------------------------
8735
8736In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8737response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8738request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8739which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008740against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008741
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008742If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
8743to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
8744but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
8745HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
8746stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
8747because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
8748a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
8749still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008751This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8752in section 4.2 :
8753
8754 - reqadd <string>
8755 - reqallow <search>
8756 - reqiallow <search>
8757 - reqdel <search>
8758 - reqidel <search>
8759 - reqdeny <search>
8760 - reqideny <search>
8761 - reqpass <search>
8762 - reqipass <search>
8763 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8764 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8765 - reqtarpit <search>
8766 - reqitarpit <search>
8767 - rspadd <string>
8768 - rspdel <search>
8769 - rspidel <search>
8770 - rspdeny <search>
8771 - rspideny <search>
8772 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8773 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8774
8775With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8776is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8777parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8778prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8779Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8780
8781 \t for a tab
8782 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8783 \n for a new line (LF)
8784 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8785 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8786 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8787 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8788 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8789
8790The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8791portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8792above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8793regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
87949 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8795is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8796
8797The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8798after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8799
8800Notes related to these keywords :
8801---------------------------------
8802 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8803 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8804 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8805
8806 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8807 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8808 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8809
8810 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8811 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8812 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8813 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8814 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8815
8816 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8817 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8818 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8819 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8820 useless headers before adding new ones.
8821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008822 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008823 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8824
8825 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8826 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8827 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8828
8829 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8830 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008831 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008832
8833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088347. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8835----------------------------------
8836
8837Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8838client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8839The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8840these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8841but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8842data called patterns.
8843
8844
88457.1. ACL basics
8846---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008847
8848The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8849content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8850from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8851simple :
8852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008853 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008854 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008855 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8856 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008858The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8859adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008860
8861In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008863 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008864
8865This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8866Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8867and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008868an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8869conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8870as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8871are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008872
8873ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8874'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8875which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8876
8877There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8878performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008880The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8881specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8882this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008883methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8884ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008885
8886Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8887 - boolean
8888 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8889 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8890 - string
8891 - data block
8892
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008893Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8894converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8895would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8896The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8897which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008899The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8900 - boolean
8901 - integer or integer range
8902 - IP address / network
8903 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8904 - regular expression
8905 - hex block
8906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008907The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8908
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008909 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8910 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008911 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008912 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008914The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8915read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8916if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8917lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8918will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8919beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8920a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8921lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8922exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8923
8924Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8925loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8926
8927 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8928
8929In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8930the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8931case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8932as well.
8933
8934The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8935sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8936do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8937methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8938is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8939obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8940followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8941default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8942that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8943string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8944
8945There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8946sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8947be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008948
8949 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8950 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008951 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8952 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8953 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8954 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008955
8956 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8957 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008958 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008959
8960 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008961 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008962
8963 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008964 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008965
8966 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8967 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8968
8969 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8970 binary or string samples.
8971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008972 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8973 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008975 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8976 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8977 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008979 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8980 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008982 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8983 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008985 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8986 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008988 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8989 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008990 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008992 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8993 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8994 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008995
8996For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8997request, it is possible to do :
8998
8999 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9000
9001In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9002buffer, one would use the following acl :
9003
9004 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9005
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009006On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9007possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9008
9009 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009011All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9012criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9013method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9014to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9015criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9016the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009018If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
9019the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
9020example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009022 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9023 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9024 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9025 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009026
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009027
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009028The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009029and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9030combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
9031the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009033 +-------------------------------------------------+
9034 | Input sample type |
9035 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9036 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
9037 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9038 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9039 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009040 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009041 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009042 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009043 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009044 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009045 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009046 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009047 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009048 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009049 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009050 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009051 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009052 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009053 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009054 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009055 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009056 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009057 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009058 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009059 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009060 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009061 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9062 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9063 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009064
9065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090667.1.1. Matching booleans
9067------------------------
9068
9069In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9070Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9071When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9072that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9073
9074Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9075return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9076"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9077
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090797.1.2. Matching integers
9080------------------------
9081
9082Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9083enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9084to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9085
9086Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9087matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9088lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009089
9090For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9091unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9092representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9093
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009094As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9095two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9096instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9097ranges and operators.
9098
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009099For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009100operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9101Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9102of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009103
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009104Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009105
9106 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9107 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9108 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9109 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9110 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9111
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009112For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009113
9114 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9115
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009116This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9117
9118 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9119
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091217.1.3. Matching strings
9122-----------------------
9123
9124String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9125different forms :
9126
9127 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9128 patterns ;
9129
9130 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9131 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9132
9133 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9134 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9135
9136 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9137 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9138
9139 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9140 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9141 matches.
9142
9143 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9144 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9145 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009146
9147String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9148exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9149characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9150string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9151to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009152before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009153
9154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091557.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9156---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009157
9158Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9159they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9160possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9161passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9162the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009163the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9164match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009165
9166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091677.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9168-------------------------------------
9169
9170It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9171not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9172a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9173to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9174digits may be used upper or lower case.
9175
9176Example :
9177 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9178 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9179
9180
91817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9182---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009183
9184IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9185netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9186within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009187host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009188difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9189at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9190does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9191parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009192
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009193IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9194Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9195trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9196IPv6 patterns.
9197
9198HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9199following situations :
9200 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9201 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9202 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9203 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9204 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9205 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9206 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9207 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9208 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9209 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009211
92127.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9213----------------------------------
9214
9215Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9216combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9217
9218 - AND (implicit)
9219 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9220 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009222A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009224 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009226Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9227indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009229For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9230"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9231requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9232is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9233
9234 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9235 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9236 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9237 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9238
9239To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9240and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9241
9242 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9243 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9244 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9245 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9246
9247 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9248 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9249 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9250 use_backend www if host_www
9251
9252It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9253expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9254be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9255the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9256
9257 The following rule :
9258
9259 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9260 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9261
9262 Can also be written that way :
9263
9264 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9265
9266It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9267to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9268simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9269sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9270good use is the following :
9271
9272 With named ACLs :
9273
9274 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9275 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9276 monitor fail if site_dead
9277
9278 With anonymous ACLs :
9279
9280 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9281
9282See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9283
9284
92857.3. Fetching samples
9286---------------------
9287
9288Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9289against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9290sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9291ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9292of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9293available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9294
9295This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9296Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9297compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9298deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9299
9300The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9301matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9302method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9303indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9304
9305As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9306when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9307mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9308the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9309ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9310
9311Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9312multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9313when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9314incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9315are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9316is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9317all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9318
9319Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9320 - name
9321 - name(arg1)
9322 - name(arg1,arg2)
9323
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009324Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9325of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9326is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9327was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9328has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9329unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9330
9331These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9332sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9333the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9334support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009336The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009338 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9339 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9340 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009342 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9343 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9344 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009346 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9347 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9348 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9349 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9350 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9351
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009352 http_date([<offset>])
9353 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9354 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9355 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9356 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9357 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9358 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9359 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9360 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009361
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009362 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9363 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9364 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9365 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9366 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9367 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9368 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9369 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9370 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9371 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9372 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9373 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9374 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9375 the map* converters.
9376
9377 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9378 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9379 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9380 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9381
9382 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9383 | `-_ out | | | |
9384 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9385 | / match `-_ | | | |
9386 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9387 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9388 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9389 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9390 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9391 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9392 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9393 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9394 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9395 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9396
9397 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9398 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9399 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9400 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9401 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9402 trailing spaces/tabs.
9403
9404 Example :
9405
9406 # this is a comment and is ignored
9407 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9408 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9409 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9410 | | | `----------- value
9411 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9412 | `---------------------------- key
9413 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094157.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9416--------------------------------------------
9417
9418A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9419not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9420"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9421The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9422
9423always_false : boolean
9424 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9425 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9426
9427always_true : boolean
9428 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9429 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9430
9431avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009432 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009433 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9434 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9435 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9436 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9437 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9438 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9439 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9440 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9441 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9442 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9443 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9444 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9445 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009447be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009448 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9449 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9450 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9451 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9452 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009454be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9455 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9456 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9457 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9458 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9459 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9460 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009461
9462 Example :
9463 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9464 backend dynamic
9465 mode http
9466 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9467 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009469connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9470 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
9471 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
9472 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9473 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009474
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009475 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009476 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009477 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9478
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009479 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9480 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009481
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009482 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009483 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009484 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009485 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9486 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009487 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009488 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009489
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009490 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9491 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009492 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009493 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009494
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009495date([<offset>]) : integer
9496 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9497 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9498 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9499 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009500 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9501
9502 Example :
9503
9504 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9505 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009506
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009507env(<name>) : string
9508 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9509 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9510 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9511 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9512 certain way.
9513
9514 Examples :
9515 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9516 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9517
9518 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9519 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009521fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9522 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009523 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9524 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009525 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9526 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9527 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9528 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9529 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009531fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9532 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9533 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9534 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9535 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9536 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9537 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9538 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9539 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009540
9541 Example :
9542 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9543 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9544 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9545 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9546 frontend mail
9547 bind :25
9548 mode tcp
9549 maxconn 100
9550 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9551 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9552 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9553 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009555nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9556 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9557 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9558 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009559 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9560 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9561 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009563queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009564 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9565 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9566 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009567 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9568 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9569 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9570 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9571 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9572
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009573rand([<range>]) : integer
9574 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9575 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9576 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9577 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9578 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009580srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9581 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9582 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9583 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9584 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9585 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9586 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9587 methods.
9588
9589srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9590 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9591 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9592 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9593 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9594 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9595 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9596 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9597
9598srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9599 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9600 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
9601 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
9602 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9603 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9604 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9605 overloading servers).
9606
9607 Example :
9608 # Redirect to a separate back
9609 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9610 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9611 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9612
9613table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9614 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9615 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9616
9617table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9618 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9619 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9620 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9621
9622
96237.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9624----------------------------------
9625
9626The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9627closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9628methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9629sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9630TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009631the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9632counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9633"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009634argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9635the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9636this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009637
9638be_id : integer
9639 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9640 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9641
9642dst : ip
9643 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9644 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9645 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9646 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9647 RFC 4291.
9648
9649dst_conn : integer
9650 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9651 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9652 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9653 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9654 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9655 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9656 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9657 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009659dst_port : integer
9660 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9661 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9662 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9663 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9664 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9665 an HTTP header.
9666
9667fe_id : integer
9668 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9669 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9670 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9671
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009672sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9673sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9674sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9675sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009676 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9677 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9678 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9679
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009680sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9681sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9682sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9683sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009684 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9685 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9686 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9687
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009688sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9689sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9690sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9691sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009692 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9693 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009694 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9695 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9696 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009697
9698 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9699 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009700 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9701 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9702 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009703 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9704 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9705
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009706sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9707sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9708sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9709sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009710 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9711 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9712
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009713sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9714sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9715sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9716sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009717 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9718 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9719 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9720
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009721sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9722sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9723sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9724sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009725 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9726 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9727 See also src_conn_rate.
9728
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009729sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9730sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9731sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9732sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009733 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009734 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009735
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009736sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9737sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9738sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9739sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009740 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9741 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9742 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009743 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9744 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9745 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009746
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009747sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9748sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9749sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9750sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009751 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9752 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9753 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9754
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009755sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9756sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9757sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9758sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009759 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9760 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9761 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9762 src_http_err_rate.
9763
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009764sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9765sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9766sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9767sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009768 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9769 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9770 src_http_req_cnt.
9771
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009772sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9773sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9774sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9775sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009776 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9777 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9778 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9779 src_http_req_rate.
9780
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009781sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9782sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9783sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9784sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009785 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009786 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9787 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9788 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9789 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009790
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009791 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9792 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009793 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9794
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009795sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9796sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9797sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9798sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009799 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9800 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9801 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9802 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9803
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009804sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9805sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9806sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9807sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009808 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9809 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9810 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9811 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9812
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009813sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9814sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9815sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9816sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009817 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9818 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9819 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9820 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009821 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009822 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9823
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009824sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9825sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9826sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9827sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009828 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9829 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9830 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9831 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9832 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009833 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009834
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009835sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9836sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9837sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9838sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009839 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9840 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9841 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9842
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009843sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9844sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9845sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9846sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009847 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9848 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009849 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009850 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9851 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009852 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9853 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9854 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009856so_id : integer
9857 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9858 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9859 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009861src : ip
9862 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9863 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9864 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9865 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9866 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9867 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9868 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009869
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009870 Example:
9871 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9872 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009874src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9875 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9876 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9877 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009878 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009880src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9881 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9882 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009883 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009884 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009886src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9887 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9888 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9889 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9890 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9891 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9892 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009893
9894 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9895 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9896 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9897 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009898 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009899 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9900 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009902src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009903 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009904 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009905 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009906 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009908src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009909 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009910 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9911 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009912 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009914src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9915 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9916 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9917 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009918 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009920src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009921 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009922 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009923 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009924 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009926src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009927 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009928 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009929 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9930 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009931 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9932 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9933 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009935src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9936 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9937 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009938 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009939 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009940 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009942src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9943 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9944 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9945 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9946 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009947 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009949src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9950 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9951 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9952 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009953 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009955src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9956 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9957 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9958 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009959 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009960 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009962src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9963 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9964 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9965 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009966 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009967 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9968 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009969
9970 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009971 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009972 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009974src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9975 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9976 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9977 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9978 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009979 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9980 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9983 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9984 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009985 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9986 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009987 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009989src_port : integer
9990 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9991 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9992 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9993 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009995src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9996 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009997 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9998 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9999 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010000 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010002src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10003 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10004 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10005 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10006 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010007 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010009src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10010 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10011 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10012 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10013 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10014 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10015 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10016 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10017 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010018
10019 Example :
10020 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10021 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10022 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10023 listen ssh
10024 bind :22
10025 mode tcp
10026 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010027 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010028 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010029 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010031srv_id : integer
10032 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10033 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10034 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010035
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100377.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
10038----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010040The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10041closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10042when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10043usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
10044future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010046ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10047 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10048 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10049 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10050 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10051 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010053ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10054 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10055 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10056 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10057 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010059ssl_c_err : integer
10060 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10061 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10062 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10063 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10064 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010066ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10067 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10068 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10069 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10070 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10071 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10072 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10073 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10074 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010076 ACL derivatives :
10077 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010079ssl_c_key_alg : string
10080 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10081 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10082 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010084 ACL derivatives :
10085 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010087ssl_c_notafter : string
10088 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10089 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10090 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010092 ACL derivatives :
10093 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010095ssl_c_notbefore : string
10096 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10097 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10098 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010100 ACL derivatives :
10101 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010103ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10104 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10105 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10106 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10107 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10108 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10109 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10110 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10111 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010113 ACL derivatives :
10114 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010116ssl_c_serial : binary
10117 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10118 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10119 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010121 ACL derivatives :
10122 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010124ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10125 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10126 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10127 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010129ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10130 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10131 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10132 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010134 ACL derivatives :
10135 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
10136
10137ssl_c_used : boolean
10138 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10139 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010141ssl_c_verify : integer
10142 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10143 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10144 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10145 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010147ssl_c_version : integer
10148 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10149 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010151ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10152 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10153 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10154 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10155 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010156 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010157 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10158 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10159 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161 ACL derivatives :
10162 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164ssl_f_key_alg : string
10165 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10166 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10167 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010169 ACL derivatives :
10170 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010172ssl_f_notafter : string
10173 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10174 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10175 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010177 ACL derivatives :
10178 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010180ssl_f_notbefore : string
10181 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10182 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10183 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010185 ACL derivatives :
10186 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010188ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10189 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10190 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10191 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10192 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10193 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10194 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10195 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10196 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010198 ACL derivatives :
10199 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010201ssl_f_serial : binary
10202 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10203 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10204 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010206 ACL derivatives :
10207 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010209ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10210 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10211 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10212 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010214 ACL derivatives :
10215 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010217ssl_f_version : integer
10218 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10219 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10220
10221ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010222 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10223 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10224 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010226 Example :
10227 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10228 listen http-https
10229 bind :80
10230 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10231 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10232
10233ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10234 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10235 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10236
10237ssl_fc_alpn : string
10238 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
10239 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10240 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10241 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10242 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10243 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10244 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10245 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10246 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10247
10248 ACL derivatives :
10249 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010251ssl_fc_cipher : string
10252 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10253 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010255 ACL derivatives :
10256 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010258ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010259 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10260 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010261 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10262 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10263 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10264 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010266ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10267 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010268 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10269 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10270 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10271 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010273ssl_fc_npn : string
10274 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
10275 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10276 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10277 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10278 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10279 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10280 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10281 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010283 ACL derivatives :
10284 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010286ssl_fc_protocol : string
10287 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10288 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010290 ACL derivatives :
10291 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10292
10293ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10294 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10295 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10296 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10297 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010299ssl_fc_sni : string
10300 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10301 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10302 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10303 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10304 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10305
10306 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10307 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10308 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010309 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10310 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010312 ACL derivatives :
10313 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10314 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10315 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010317ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10318 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10319 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010320
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103227.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10323------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010325Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10326sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10327only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10328For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10329be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10330can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10331sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10332for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10333content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010335payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10336 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10337 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10338 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010340payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10341 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10342 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10343 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010345req.len : integer
10346req_len : integer (deprecated)
10347 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10348 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10349 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10350 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10351 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10352 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10353 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10354 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010356req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10357 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010358 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10359 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10360 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10361 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010363 ACL alternatives :
10364 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010366req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10367 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10368 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10369 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10370 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010372 ACL alternatives :
10373 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010375 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010377req.proto_http : boolean
10378req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10379 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10380 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10381 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10382 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10383 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10384 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10385 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010387 Example:
10388 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10389 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10390 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010391 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010393req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10394rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10395 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10396 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10397 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10398 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10399 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10400 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10401 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010403 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10404 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10405 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10406 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10407 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10408 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010410 ACL derivatives :
10411 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010413 Example :
10414 listen tse-farm
10415 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10416 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10417 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10418 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10419 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10420 persist rdp-cookie
10421 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10422 # This is only useful makes sense if
10423 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10424 stick-table type string size 204800
10425 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10426 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10427 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010429 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10430 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010432req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10433rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10434 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10435 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10436 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10437 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010439 ACL derivatives :
10440 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010442req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10443req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10444 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10445 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10446 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10447 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10448 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10449 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10450 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452req.ssl_sni : string
10453req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10454 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10455 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10456 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10457 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10458 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10459 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10460 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10461 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10462 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10463 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10464 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10465 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010467 ACL derivatives :
10468 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010470 Examples :
10471 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10472 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10473 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10474 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10475 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010477res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10478rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10479 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10480 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10481 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10482 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10483 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10484 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10485 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010487req.ssl_ver : integer
10488req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10489 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10490 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10491 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10492 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10493 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10494 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10495 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10496 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10497 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010499 ACL derivatives :
10500 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010501
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010502res.len : integer
10503 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10504 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10505 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10506 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10507 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10508 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10509 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10510 content inspection.
10511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010512res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10513 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010514 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10515 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10516 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10517 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010519res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10520 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10521 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10522 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10523 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010525 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010527wait_end : boolean
10528 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10529 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10530 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10531 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10532 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10533 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10534 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10535 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010537 Examples :
10538 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10539 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10540 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010542 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10543 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10544 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10545 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10546 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10547 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10548 tcp-request content reject
10549
10550
105517.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10552--------------------------------------
10553
10554It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10555This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10556data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10557its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10558HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10559content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10560to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10561more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10562response are indexed.
10563
10564base : string
10565 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10566 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10567 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10568 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10569 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10570 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10571 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10572 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10573
10574 ACL derivatives :
10575 base : exact string match
10576 base_beg : prefix match
10577 base_dir : subdir match
10578 base_dom : domain match
10579 base_end : suffix match
10580 base_len : length match
10581 base_reg : regex match
10582 base_sub : substring match
10583
10584base32 : integer
10585 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10586 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10587 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10588 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10589
10590base32+src : binary
10591 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10592 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10593 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10594 per-URL counters.
10595
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010596capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10597 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10598 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10599 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10600
10601capture.req.method : string
10602 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10603 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10604 because it's allocated.
10605
10606capture.req.uri : string
10607 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
10608 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
10609 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
10610 allocated.
10611
10612capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10613 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10614 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10615 The first entry is an index of 0.
10616 See also: "capture response header"
10617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010618req.cook([<name>]) : string
10619cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10620 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10621 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10622 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10623 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10624 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10625 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10626 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10627 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10628
10629 ACL derivatives :
10630 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10631 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10632 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10633 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10634 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10635 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10636 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10637 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010639req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10640cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10641 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10642 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10645cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10646 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10647 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10648 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10649 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010651cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10652 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10653 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10654 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10655 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10656 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10657 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10658 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10659 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10660 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10661 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010663hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10664 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10665 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10666 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10667 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10668 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010670req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10671 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10672 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10673 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10674 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10675 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10676 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10677 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10678 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010680req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10681 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10682 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10683 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10684 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010686req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10687 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10688 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10689 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10690 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10691 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10692 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10693 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10694 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10695 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10696 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10697 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010699 ACL derivatives :
10700 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10701 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10702 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10703 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10704 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10705 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10706 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10707 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10708
10709req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10710hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10711 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10712 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10713 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10714 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10715 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10716 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10717 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10718 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10719 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10720
10721req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10722hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10723 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10724 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10725 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10726 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10727 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10728 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10729 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10730 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10731
10732req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10733hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10734 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10735 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10736 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10737 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10738 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10739 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10740 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10741
10742http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10743 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10744 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10745 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10746 basic auth is supported.
10747
10748http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10749 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10750 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10751 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10752 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10753 basic auth is supported.
10754
10755 ACL derivatives :
10756 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10757
10758http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010759 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10760 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010761 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10762 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010764method : integer + string
10765 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10766 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10767 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10768 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10769 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10770 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10771 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010773 ACL derivatives :
10774 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010776 Example :
10777 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10778 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10779 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010781path : string
10782 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10783 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10784 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10785 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10786 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10787 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10788 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010790 ACL derivatives :
10791 path : exact string match
10792 path_beg : prefix match
10793 path_dir : subdir match
10794 path_dom : domain match
10795 path_end : suffix match
10796 path_len : length match
10797 path_reg : regex match
10798 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010800req.ver : string
10801req_ver : string (deprecated)
10802 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10803 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10804 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010806 ACL derivatives :
10807 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010809res.comp : boolean
10810 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10811 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10812 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010814res.comp_algo : string
10815 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10816 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10817 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010819res.cook([<name>]) : string
10820scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10821 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10822 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10823 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010825 ACL derivatives :
10826 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010828res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10829scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10830 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10831 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10832 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010834res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10835scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10836 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10837 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10838 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010840res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10841 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10842 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10843 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10844 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10845 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10846 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10847 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10848 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10849 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010851res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10852 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10853 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10854 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10855 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10856 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010858res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10859shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10860 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10861 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10862 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10863 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10864 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10865 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10866 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10867 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010869 ACL derivatives :
10870 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10871 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10872 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10873 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10874 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10875 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10876 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10877 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10878
10879res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10880shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10881 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10882 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10883 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10884 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10885 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010887res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10888shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10889 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10890 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10891 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10892 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10893 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10894 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010896res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10897shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10898 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10899 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10900 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10901 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10902 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10903 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010905res.ver : string
10906resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10907 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10908 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010910 ACL derivatives :
10911 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010913set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10914 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10915 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10916 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10917 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010919 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10920 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010922 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010924status : integer
10925 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10926 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10927 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010929url : string
10930 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10931 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10932 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10933 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10934 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10935 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10936 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010938 ACL derivatives :
10939 url : exact string match
10940 url_beg : prefix match
10941 url_dir : subdir match
10942 url_dom : domain match
10943 url_end : suffix match
10944 url_len : length match
10945 url_reg : regex match
10946 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010948url_ip : ip
10949 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10950 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10951 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10952 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10953 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10954 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10955 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010957url_port : integer
10958 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10959 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10960 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10961 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010963urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10964url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10965 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10966 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10967 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10968 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10969 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10970 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10971 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10972 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10973 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010975 ACL derivatives :
10976 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10977 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10978 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10979 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10980 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10981 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10982 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10983 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010984
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010986 Example :
10987 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10988 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10989 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10990 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010992urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10993 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10994 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10995 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010996
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200109987.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010999---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011001Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11002every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011003order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011005ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11006---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011007FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011008HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011009HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11010HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011011HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11012HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11013HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11014HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11015LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011016METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11017METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11018METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11019METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11020METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11021METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011022RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011023REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011024TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011025WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11026---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011027
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110298. Logging
11030----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011031
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011032One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11033provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11034very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11035provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11036state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011037to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011038headers.
11039
11040In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11041about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11042send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11043
11044 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11045 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11046 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11047 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11048 at the termination.
11049
11050The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11051allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11052as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11053while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11054real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11055delay.
11056
11057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110588.1. Log levels
11059---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011060
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011061TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011062source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011063HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11064in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11065track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11066syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11067about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011068
11069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110708.2. Log formats
11071----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011072
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011073HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011074and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11075slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11076options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011077
11078 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11079 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11080 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11081 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11082 extents.
11083
11084 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11085 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11086 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11087 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11088 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11089
11090 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11091 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11092 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11093 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11094 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11095
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011096 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11097 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11098 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11099 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11100
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011101 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11102
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011103Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11104specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11105field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11106servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11107always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11108identifier.
11109
11110Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11111 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11112 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11113 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11114 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11115
11116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111178.2.1. Default log format
11118-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011119
11120This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11121as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11122format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11123
11124 Example :
11125 listen www
11126 mode http
11127 log global
11128 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11129
11130 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11131 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11132 (www/HTTP)
11133
11134 Field Format Extract from the example above
11135 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11136 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11137 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11138 4 'to' to
11139 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11140 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11141
11142Detailed fields description :
11143 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11144 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11145 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11146 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11147 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11148 and processed the connection.
11149 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11150
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011151In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11152"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11153connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11154
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011155It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11156will eventually disappear.
11157
11158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111598.2.2. TCP log format
11160---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011161
11162The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11163is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11164information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11165counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11166emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11167environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11168the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11169sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011170specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11171not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11172fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11173marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011174
11175 Example :
11176 frontend fnt
11177 mode tcp
11178 option tcplog
11179 log global
11180 default_backend bck
11181
11182 backend bck
11183 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11184
11185 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11186 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11187 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11188
11189 Field Format Extract from the example above
11190 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11191 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11192 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11193 4 frontend_name fnt
11194 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11195 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11196 7 bytes_read* 212
11197 8 termination_state --
11198 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11199 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11200
11201Detailed fields description :
11202 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011203 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11204 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11205 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11206 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11207 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011208
11209 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011210 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11211 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11212 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011213
11214 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11215 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11216 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11217 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11218
11219 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11220 and processed the connection.
11221
11222 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11223 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11224 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11225 applications.
11226
11227 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11228 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11229 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11230 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11231 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11232
11233 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11234 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11235 See "Timers" below for more details.
11236
11237 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11238 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11239 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11240 "Timers" below for more details.
11241
11242 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11243 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11244 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11245 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11246 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11247 details.
11248
11249 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11250 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11251 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11252 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11253 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11254
11255 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11256 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11257 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11258 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11259 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11260 for more details.
11261
11262 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011263 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011264 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11265 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11266 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011267 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011268
11269 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11270 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11271 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11272 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11273 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11274 caused by a denial of service attack.
11275
11276 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11277 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11278 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11279 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11280 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11281 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11282 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11283 denial of service attack.
11284
11285 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11286 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11287 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11288 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11289 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11290 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11291 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11292 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11293 be processed than on other servers.
11294
11295 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11296 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11297 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11298 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11299 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11300 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11301 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11302 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11303 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11304 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11305 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11306 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11307 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11308
11309 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11310 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11311 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11312 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11313 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11314 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11315 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11316 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11317
11318 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11319 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11320 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11321 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11322 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11323 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11324 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11325 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11326 occurs.
11327
11328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113298.2.3. HTTP log format
11330----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011331
11332The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11333is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11334the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11335are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11336emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11337generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11338"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11339which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011340frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11341is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011342
11343Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11344slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11345with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11346
11347 Example :
11348 frontend http-in
11349 mode http
11350 option httplog
11351 log global
11352 default_backend bck
11353
11354 backend static
11355 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11356
11357 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11358 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11359 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011360 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011361
11362 Field Format Extract from the example above
11363 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11364 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11365 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11366 4 frontend_name http-in
11367 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11368 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11369 7 status_code 200
11370 8 bytes_read* 2750
11371 9 captured_request_cookie -
11372 10 captured_response_cookie -
11373 11 termination_state ----
11374 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11375 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11376 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11377 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11378 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011379
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011380
11381Detailed fields description :
11382 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011383 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11384 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11385 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11386 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11387 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011388
11389 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011390 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11391 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11392 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011393
11394 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11395 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11396 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11397 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11398 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11399
11400 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11401 and processed the connection.
11402
11403 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11404 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11405 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11406
11407 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11408 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11409 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11410 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11411 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11412 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11413
11414 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11415 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11416 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11417 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11418 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11419 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11420
11421 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11422 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11423 See "Timers" below for more details.
11424
11425 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11426 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11427 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11428 below for more details.
11429
11430 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11431 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11432 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11433 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11434 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11435 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11436 for more details.
11437
11438 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11439 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11440 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11441 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11442 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11443 details.
11444
11445 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11446 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11447 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11448
11449 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11450 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11451 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11452 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11453 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11454 overflowing.
11455
11456 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11457 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11458 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11459 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11460 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11461 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11462 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11463 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11464
11465 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11466 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11467 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11468 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11469 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11470 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11471 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11472 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11473
11474 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11475 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11476 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11477 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11478 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11479 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11480 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11481
11482 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011483 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011484 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11485 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11486 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011487 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011488 system.
11489
11490 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11491 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11492 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11493 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11494 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11495 caused by a denial of service attack.
11496
11497 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11498 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11499 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11500 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11501 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11502 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11503 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11504 denial of service attack.
11505
11506 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11507 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11508 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11509 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11510 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11511 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11512 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11513 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11514 processed than on other servers.
11515
11516 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11517 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11518 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11519 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11520 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11521 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11522 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11523 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11524 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11525 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11526 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11527 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11528 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11529
11530 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11531 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11532 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11533 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11534 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11535 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11536 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11537 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11538
11539 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11540 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11541 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11542 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11543 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11544 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11545 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11546 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11547 occurs.
11548
11549 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11550 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11551 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11552 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11553 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11554 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11555 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11556 cookies" below for more details.
11557
11558 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11559 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11560 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11561 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11562 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11563 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11564 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11565 and cookies" below for more details.
11566
11567 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11568 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11569 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11570 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11571 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11572 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11573 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11574 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11575
11576
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200115778.2.4. Custom log format
11578------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011579
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011580The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011581mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011582
11583HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11584Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11585separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11586prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11587
11588Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11589variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11590string formats ("Q").
11591
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011592If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011593as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011594less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11595the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11596
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011597Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011598In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceeded by another '%' resulting
11599in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011600
11601Flags are :
11602 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011603 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011604
11605 Example:
11606
11607 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11608 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11609
11610At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11611
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011612 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11613 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011614
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011615the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011616
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011617 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011618 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011619 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011620
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011621and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11622
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011623 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011624 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11625
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011626Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11627
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011628 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011629 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011630 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11631 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11632 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011633 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11634 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11635 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011636 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011637 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011638 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011639 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011640 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011641 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011642 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11643 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011644 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011645 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11646 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011647 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011648 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11649 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011650 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11651 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11652 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011653 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011654 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11655 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011656 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011657 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11658 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11659 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011660 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011661 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11662 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11663 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11664 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011665 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011666 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011667 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011668 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011669 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011670 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011671 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11672 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11673 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011674 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011675 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11676 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011677 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011678 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011679 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011680 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011681
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011682 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011683
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011684
116858.2.5. Error log format
11686-----------------------
11687
11688When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11689protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11690By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11691"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11692will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11693logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11694
11695The format looks like this :
11696
11697 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11698 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11699 Connection error during SSL handshake
11700
11701 Field Format Extract from the example above
11702 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11703 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11704 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11705 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11706 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11707
11708These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11709failures.
11710
11711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117128.3. Advanced logging options
11713-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011714
11715Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11716just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11717options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11718for more information about their usage.
11719
11720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117218.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11722------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011723
11724It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11725haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11726commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11727monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11728ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11729
11730 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11731 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11732 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11733 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11734
11735 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11736 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11737 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11738 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11739 such as other load-balancers.
11740
11741 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11742 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11743 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11744
11745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117468.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11747----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011748
11749The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11750what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11751or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11752"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11753just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11754log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11755after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11756is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11757with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11758with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11759
11760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117618.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11762------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011763
11764Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11765for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11766"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11767retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11768raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11769a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11770file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11771you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11772"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11773
11774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117758.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11776--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011777
11778Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11779multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11780them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11781"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11782logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11783error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11784and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11785too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11786useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11787alternative.
11788
11789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117908.4. Timing events
11791------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011792
11793Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11794reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11795the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11796frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11797mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11798
11799 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11800 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11801 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11802 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11803 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11804
11805 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11806 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11807 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11808 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11809 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11810
11811 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11812 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11813 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11814 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11815 connection never established.
11816
11817 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11818 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11819 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11820 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11821 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11822 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11823 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11824 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11825 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11826 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11827 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11828
11829 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11830 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11831 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11832 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11833 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11834
11835 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11836
11837 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11838 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11839 negative.
11840
11841These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11842protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11843that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011844due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011845close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11846session has been aborted on timeout.
11847
11848Most common cases :
11849
11850 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11851 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11852 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11853 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11854 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11855 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11856 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11857 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11858 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011859 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11860 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11861 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011862
11863 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11864 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11865 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11866 of ms on remote networks.
11867
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011868 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11869 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11870 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011871
11872 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11873 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11874 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11875 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11876 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11877 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11878 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11879 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11880 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11881 to the server until another one is released.
11882
11883Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11884
11885 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11886 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11887 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11888
11889 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11890 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11891 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11892
11893 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11894 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11895 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11896 flags.
11897
11898 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11899 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11900 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11901 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11902 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11903 the client connection was maintained open.
11904
11905 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11906 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11907 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11908 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11909
11910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119118.5. Session state at disconnection
11912-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011913
11914TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11915"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
119162-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11917each of which has a special meaning :
11918
11919 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11920 session to terminate :
11921
11922 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11923
11924 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11925 server explicitly refused it.
11926
11927 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11928 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11929 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11930 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011931 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11932
11933 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11934 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011935
11936 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11937 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11938 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11939 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11940 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11941
11942 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11943 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11944 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11945 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11946 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11947
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011948 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11949 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11950
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011951 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11952 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11953 backup connections when going up.
11954
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011955 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11956
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011957 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11958 send or receive data.
11959
11960 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11961 send or receive data.
11962
11963 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11964 with nothing left in the buffers.
11965
11966 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11967
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011968 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011969 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11970
11971 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11972 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11973 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11974 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11975 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11976
11977 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11978 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11979
11980 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11981 server (HTTP only).
11982
11983 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11984
11985 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11986 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11987 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11988
11989 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11990 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11991 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11992
11993 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11994
11995 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11996 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11997
11998 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11999 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12000 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12001
12002 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12003 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012004 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12005 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012006
12007 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12008 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12009 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12010 another server.
12011
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012012 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012013 server.
12014
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012015 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12016 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12017 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12018 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12019
12020 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12021 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12022 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12023 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12024
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012025 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12026 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12027 "use-server" rule).
12028
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012029 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12030
12031 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12032 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12033
12034 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12035
12036 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12037 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12038 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12039
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012040 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12041 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
12042 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
12043 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12044 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12045
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012046 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12047
12048 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12049 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12050
12051 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12052
12053 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12054
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012055The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12056was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012057helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12058starvation, attacks, etc...
12059
12060The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12061alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12062easier finding and understanding.
12063
12064 Flags Reason
12065
12066 -- Normal termination.
12067
12068 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12069 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12070 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12071 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12072
12073 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12074 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12075 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12076 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12077 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12078 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012079
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012080 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12081 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012082 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012083
12084 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12085 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12086 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12087
12088 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12089 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12090 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12091 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12092 the server takes too long to respond.
12093
12094 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12095 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12096 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12097 long a time to respond.
12098
12099 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12100 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12101 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12102 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12103 and the client.
12104
12105 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12106 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12107 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12108 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12109 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12110 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12111
12112 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12113 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012114 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12115 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12116 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12117 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012118
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012119 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12120 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012122 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012123 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12124 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12125 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12126 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12127 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12128
12129 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12130 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12131 503 or 504 here.
12132
12133 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12134 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12135 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12136 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12137 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12138
12139 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12140 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012141 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012142 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12143 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12144
12145 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12146 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12147 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12148 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12149 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12150 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12151 between haproxy and the server.
12152
12153 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12154 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12155 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12156 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12157 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12158 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12159 solution is to fix the application.
12160
12161 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12162 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12163 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12164 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12165 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12166 external attacks.
12167
12168 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12169 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012170 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012171 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12172 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12173
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012174 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12175 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12176 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012177 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12178 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012179
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012180 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12181 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12182 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12183 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012184 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12185 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12186 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12187 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12188 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012189
12190 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12191 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12192 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12193 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12194
12195 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12196 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12197 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12198 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12199
12200 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12201 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12202 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12203 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12204
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012205The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12206persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12207important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12208re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12209
12210 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12211
12212 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12213 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12214 set on a GET request.
12215
12216 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12217 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012218 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012219 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12220
12221 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12222 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12223 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12224
12225 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12226 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12227 already got a cookie.
12228
12229 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12230 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12231 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12232 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12233 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12234
12235 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12236 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12237 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12238
12239 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12240 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12241 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12242
12243 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12244 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12245
12246 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12247 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12248 then advertised in the response.
12249
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122518.6. Non-printable characters
12252-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012253
12254In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12255consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12256converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12257prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12258being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12259escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12260is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12261'}' when logging headers.
12262
12263Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12264issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12265containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12266
12267Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12268the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12269performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12270
12271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122728.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12273---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012274
12275Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12276achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012277section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012278cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12279the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12280the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012281locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012282not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12283user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12284a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12285wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12286
12287 Examples :
12288 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12289 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12290
12291 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12292 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12293
12294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122958.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12296---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012297
12298Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12299proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12300the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12301server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12302
12303Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12304response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012305section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012306
12307It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012308time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12309appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012310are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12311and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12312follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12313request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12314in the logs.
12315
12316 Example :
12317 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12318 listen proxy-out
12319 mode http
12320 option httplog
12321 option logasap
12322 log global
12323 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12324
12325 # log the name of the virtual server
12326 capture request header Host len 20
12327
12328 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12329 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12330
12331 # log the beginning of the referrer
12332 capture request header Referer len 20
12333
12334 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12335 capture response header Server len 20
12336
12337 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12338 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12339
12340 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12341 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12342
12343 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12344 capture response header Via len 20
12345
12346 # log the URL location during a redirection
12347 capture response header Location len 20
12348
12349 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12350 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12351 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12352 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12353 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12354
12355 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12356 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12357 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12358 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012359 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012360
12361 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12362 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12363 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12364 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12365 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012366 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012367
12368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123698.9. Examples of logs
12370---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012371
12372These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12373them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12374reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12375
12376 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12377 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12378 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12379
12380 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12381 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12382
12383 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12384 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12385 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12386
12387 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12388 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12389
12390 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12391 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12392 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12393
12394 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012395 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012396 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12397 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12398
12399 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12400 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12401 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12402
12403 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12404 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012405 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012406 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12407 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12408 to return the 502 and not the server.
12409
12410 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012411 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012412
12413 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12414 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12415 Nothing was sent to any server.
12416
12417 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12418 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12419
12420 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12421 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12422 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12423 send a 408 return code to the client.
12424
12425 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12426 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12427
12428 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12429 5 seconds ("c----").
12430
12431 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12432 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012433 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012434
12435 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012436 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012437 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12438 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12439 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12440 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12441 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012442
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124449. Statistics and monitoring
12445----------------------------
12446
12447It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12448mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12449CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12450Unix socket.
12451
12452
124539.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012454---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012455
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012456The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12457page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012459 0. pxname: proxy name
12460 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12461 for server)
12462 2. qcur: current queued requests
12463 3. qmax: max queued requests
12464 4. scur: current sessions
12465 5. smax: max sessions
12466 6. slim: sessions limit
12467 7. stot: total sessions
12468 8. bin: bytes in
12469 9. bout: bytes out
12470 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012471 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012472 12. ereq: request errors
12473 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012474 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012475 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12476 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012477 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012478 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12479 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12480 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12481 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12482 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12483 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12484 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12485 25. qlimit: queue limit
12486 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12487 27. iid: unique proxy id
12488 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12489 29. throttle: warm up status
12490 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12491 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012492 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012493 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12494 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12495 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012496 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012497 UNK -> unknown
12498 INI -> initializing
12499 SOCKERR -> socket error
12500 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12501 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12502 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12503 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12504 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12505 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12506 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12507 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12508 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12509 disable-on-404
12510 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12511 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12512 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012513 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12514 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012515 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12516 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12517 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12518 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12519 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12520 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012521 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12522 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12523 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12524 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012525 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12526 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012527 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12528 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12529 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012530 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012531 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012532
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125349.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012535-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012536
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012537The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12538necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12539A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12540issuing commands by hand :
12541
12542 global
12543 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12544 stats timeout 2m
12545
12546It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12547the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12548never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12549situations :
12550
12551 global
12552 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12553 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12554 stats timeout 2m
12555
12556To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12557swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12558to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12559syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12560
12561 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12562 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12563
12564The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12565script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12566for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12567
12568The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12569that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12570editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12571(eg: watch a counter).
12572
12573The socket supports two operation modes :
12574 - interactive
12575 - non-interactive
12576
12577The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12578this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12579sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12580mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12581commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12582example :
12583
12584 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12585
12586The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12587entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12588for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12589sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12590"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12591after processing the last command of the same line.
12592
12593For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12594"prompt" command :
12595
12596 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12597 prompt
12598 > show info
12599 ...
12600 >
12601
12602Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12603delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12604that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12605parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012606
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012607It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12608on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12609own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012610
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012611The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12612If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12613all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12614it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12615
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012616add map <map> <key> <value>
12617 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12618 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
12619 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation.
12620
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012621clear counters
12622 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12623 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12624 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12625 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12626 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12627
12628clear counters all
12629 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12630 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12631 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12632
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012633clear map <map>
12634 Remove all entries from the map <map>.
12635
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012636clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12637 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12638
12639 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12640 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12641 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12642 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12643 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12644 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12645
12646 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12647
12648 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12649 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12650 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12651 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12652 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12653 the ACLs :
12654
12655 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12656 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12657 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12658 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12659 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12660 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12661
12662 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012663 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12664 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012665
12666 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012667 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012668 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012669 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12670 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12671 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12672 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012673
12674 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12675
12676 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012677 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012678 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12679 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012680 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12681 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12682 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012683
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012684del map <map> <key>
12685 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
12686
12687disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012688 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12689
12690 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12691 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12692 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12693 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12694 re-enabled using enable agent.
12695
12696 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12697 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12698 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12699 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12700 otherwise unchanged.
12701
12702 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12703 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12704 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12705
12706 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12707 level "admin".
12708
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012709disable frontend <frontend>
12710 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12711 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12712 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12713 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12714 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12715 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12716 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12717 on the stats page.
12718
12719 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12720 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12721
12722 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12723 level "admin".
12724
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012725disable server <backend>/<server>
12726 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12727 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12728 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12729 during the maintenance.
12730
12731 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12732 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12733
12734 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012735 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012736
12737 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12738 level "admin".
12739
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012740enable agent <backend>/<server>
12741 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12742
12743 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12744 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12745
12746 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12747 level "admin".
12748
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012749enable frontend <frontend>
12750 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12751 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12752 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12753 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12754 which was disabled.
12755
12756 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12757 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12758
12759 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12760 level "admin".
12761
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012762enable server <backend>/<server>
12763 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12764 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12765
12766 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012767 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012768
12769 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12770 level "admin".
12771
12772get weight <backend>/<server>
12773 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12774 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12775 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12776 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12777 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012778 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012779
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012780help
12781 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12782 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012783
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012784prompt
12785 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12786 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12787 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12788 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12789 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12790 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12791 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12792 command.
12793
12794quit
12795 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012796
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012797set map <map> <key> <value>
12798 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. The new value
12799 is <value>.
12800
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012801set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012802 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12803 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12804 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12805 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12806 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012807 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12808 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12809
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012810set maxconn global <maxconn>
12811 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12812 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12813 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12814 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12815 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12816 setting.
12817
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012818set rate-limit connections global <value>
12819 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12820 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12821 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12822 is passed in number of connections per second.
12823
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012824set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12825 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12826 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012827 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12828 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012829
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020012830set rate-limit sessions global <value>
12831 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
12832 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12833 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12834 is passed in number of sessions per second.
12835
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020012836set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
12837 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
12838 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12839 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12840 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
12841 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
12842
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012843set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012844 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12845 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12846 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12847 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012848 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12849 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012850
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012851set timeout cli <delay>
12852 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12853 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12854 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12855
12856set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12857 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12858 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012859 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12860 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12861 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12862 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12863 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12864 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12865 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12866 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12867 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12868 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12869 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12870 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12871 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012872
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012873show errors [<iid>]
12874 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12875 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012876 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12877 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12878 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012879
12880 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12881 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12882 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12883 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12884 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12885 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12886 are reported too.
12887
12888 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12889 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12890 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12891 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12892 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12893 code.
12894
12895 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12896 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12897 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12898 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12899 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12900 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12901 line.
12902
12903 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012904 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12905 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012906 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12907 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12908
12909 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12910 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12911 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12912 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12913 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12914 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12915 00204+ minal\r\n
12916 00211 \r\n
12917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012918 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012919 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12920 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12921 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12922 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12923 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12924 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012925
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012926show info
12927 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12928
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012929show map [<map>]
12930 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
12931 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped.
12932
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010012933show pools
12934 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
12935 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
12936 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
12937 the pools.
12938
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012939show sess
12940 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012941 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12942 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12943
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012944show sess <id>
12945 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12946 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12947 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12948 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12949 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012950 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12951 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12952 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012953
12954show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12955 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12956 possible to dump only selected items :
12957 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12958 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12959 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12960 for example:
12961 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12962 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12963 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12964
12965 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012966 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12967 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012968 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12969 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12970 Nbproc: 1
12971 Process_num: 1
12972 (...)
12973
12974 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12975 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12976 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12977 (...)
12978 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12979
12980 $
12981
12982 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12983 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12984 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12985 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012986 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012987
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012988show table
12989 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12990 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12991 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12992 entries currently in use.
12993
12994 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012995 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012996 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12997 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012998
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012999show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013000 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13001 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13002 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013003 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13004
13005 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13006 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13007 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13008 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13009 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13010
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013011 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13012 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13013 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13014 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13015 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13016 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13017
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013018
13019 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013020 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13021 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013022
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013023 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013024 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013025 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013026 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13027 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13028 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13029 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013030
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013031 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013032 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013033 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13034 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013035
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013036 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13037 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013038 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013039 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13040 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013041
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013042 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13043 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013044 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013045 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13046 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13047
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013048 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13049 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13050 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13051 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13052 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13053
13054 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13055 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13056 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013057 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13058 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013059 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13060 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013061
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013062shutdown frontend <frontend>
13063 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13064 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13065 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13066 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13067 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13068 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13069 once it is terminated.
13070
13071 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13072 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13073
13074 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13075 level "admin".
13076
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013077shutdown session <id>
13078 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13079 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13080 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13081 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13082 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13083 flag in the logs.
13084
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013085shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13086 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13087 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13088 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13089 'K' flag in the logs.
13090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013091/*
13092 * Local variables:
13093 * fill-column: 79
13094 * End:
13095 */